E 180 000 2 11 13
E 180 000 2 11 13
E 180 000 2 11 13
000
Global Presence.
Local Expertise.
www.hydac.com
Filter Technology 70.000
Electronic
Product Catalogue
Process Technology 77.000
Filter Systems 79.000
HYDAC Headquarters
HYDAC Companies
HYDAC Distributors and Service Partners
Accessories 61.000
E 180.000.2/11.13
Cooling Systems 5.700
HYDAC Electronic
HYDAC is best known for hydraulics,
systems and fluid engineering. For over
50 years, HYDAC has been developing
and manufacturing components and
system solutions for specific applications
in these fields.
Over 30 years ago, inspired by its industry
and application experience, HYDAC
expanded its portfolio to include sensors,
measuring instruments and electronic
controls.
g
pe
in
Ins
ic
e
rv
nc
Se
na
nte
ai ion
M lat
tal
Ins n
atio
imiz
Opt
E 180.000.2 /11.13
2
Note Page
The information in this brochure
relates to the operating conditions 1. Introduction 2 1
and applications described. zzIndustries / Applications / Product Range 2-7
For applications or operating
conditions not described, please 2. Electronic pressure transmitters 8 - 33 2
contact the relevant technical for general applications
department. zzHDA 4800 9
zzHDA 4700 11
zzHDA 4700 Approvals for shipping 13
Subject to technical modifications.
zzHDA 4700 CANopen 15
zzHDA 4400 17
zzHDA 4400 Approvals for shipping 19
zzHDA 4300 21
zzHDA 4300 Approvals for shipping 23
zzHDA 4100 25
zzHDA 4100 Approvals for shipping 27
zzHDA 7446 29
zzHDA 7400 CANopen 31
zzHDA 3800 for Iron and Steel Works Applications 33
3. Electronic pressure switches 36 - 79 3
for general applications
zzEDS 3400 37
zzEDS 3400 Menu navigation according to VDMA 41
zzEDS 3400 IO-Link 43
zzEDS 3300 45
zzEDS 3300 Menu navigation according to VDMA 49
zzEDS 3300 IO-Link 51
zzEDS 3100 53
zzEDS 3100 Menu navigation according to VDMA 57
zzEDS 3100 IO-Link 59
zzEDS 300 61
zzEDS 300 Approvals for shipping 65
zzEDS 8000 67
zzEDS 601 69
zzEDS 1700 71
zzEDS 4400 Programmable 73
zzEDS 4300 Programmable 75
zzEDS 820 IO-Link 77
D-66128 Saarbrücken
Telephone +49 (0)6897 509-01,
Fax +49 (0)6897 509-1726
E-mail: [email protected]
Internet: www.hydac.com
3
Page
4
Page
1
7. Accessories 382 - 403 17
zzElectrical accessories 383 - 388
for electrical connection type "4" (Binder, Series 714M18)
for electrical connection type "5" (EN 175301-803 (DIN 43650) /ISO 4400)
for electrical connection type "6" (M12×1, 4 pole)
for electrical connection type "7" (DIN 43561)
for electrical connection type "8" (M12×1, 5 pole)
for electrical connection type "P" (M12×1, 8 pole)
zzMechanical accessories 389 - 396
- Connection adapters for pressure sensors
- Mounting accessories for EDS 8000, HDA 8000, EDS 810
- Mounting accessories for EDS 3000, ETS 3000, AS 3000, ENS 3000, HNS 3000
- Mounting accessories for EDS 300, ETS 300
- Mounting accessories for EDS 1700, ETS 1700
- Mounting accessories for EDS 601
- Tank mounting sleeve for ETS 3000
- Connection blocks for ENS 3000
- Connection blocks for HLB 1300
- Connection blocks for AS 1000, AS 3000
zzAccessories for sensors for distance and position 397 - 400
- Magnets for HLT 1000, HLT 2000, HNT 1000
- Electrical accessories for HLT 2000
zzAccessories for service instruments 401 - 403
- Accessories for HMG 30X0
- Accessories for HMG 500/510
E 180.000.2 /11.13
5
Industries and applications
1
There is almost no hydraulic or Excavators
pneumatic medium or system Electronic controls and sensors
that could not be monitored and to complete the system electronics.
controlled by HYDAC measurement - Load limit control
technology - quickly, precisely and - Electro-hydraulic load sensing
safely. - Integrated operating data logging
- Controls of special equipment
It is not surprising, therefore, that the - Cut-off devices
individually designed - Safety cut-off devices
HYDAC Measuring Technology
is employed by well-known Wheel Loaders
manufacturers and operators Electronic controls and sensors
in all industries. to complete the system electronics.
These applications range from - Load limit control
analysis and diagnostics of - Electro-hydraulic load sensing
operating fluids in the laboratory - Integrated operating data logging
and on site, to controlling - Controls of special equipment
complex industrial systems and - Cut-off devices
to miniaturised systems - Safety cut-off devices
in construction and road vehicles.
Road Construction Machinery
Sensor technology and system electronics to generate
modern control concepts or ready-to-install total concepts.
- Load spectra
- Condition monitoring
- Safety systems
- Load limiting
- Function controls
- Energy management
Telescopic Cranes
Sensor technology and system electronics to generate
modern control concepts
or ready-to-install total concepts.
- Load torque limiting
- Load spectra
- Load sensing
- Load limit control
- Energy management
- Condition monitoring
Municipal Machines
Sensors, system electronics
and condition monitoring.
- Working hydraulics
- Axle suspension systems
- Cab suspension systems
- Levelling systems
Tractors
Sensors, system electronics
and condition monitoring.
- Cab suspension
- Central hydraulics
- Front axle suspension
- Transmission shift control
- Level control
- Anti-roll stabilisation
Agricultural Technology
Electronic controls and sensors
to complete the system electronics.
- Load limit control
- Electro-hydraulic load sensing
- Integrated operating data logging
- Controls of special equipment
- Cut-off devices
E 180.000.2 /11.13
6
1
Mining Aviation and Aerospace Industry
Electronic measurement technology for Sensors, system electronics
underground applications. and condition monitoring.
- Pump station / Media supply - Rocket test rigs
- Mining of raw materials - Test rigs for aircraft hydraulics
- Heading - Satellite test rigs
- Material-handling and passenger transportation - Flight simulators
- Analysis and diagnostics
- Condition monitoring
7
Electronic Pressure Transmitters
The right pressure transmitter for every application! The wide ranging
product choice from HYDAC offers solutions for all industries, whether
systems or machinery manufacture, mobile technology or for laboratory
2 applications.
The pressure transmitters are available with a variety of output signals,
connectors and fluid port connection options.
HDA 4700
HDA 4400
HDA 4300
HDA 4100
HDA 3800
HDA 7400
HDA 8700
HDA 8400
HDA 9000
4
Electronic
Pressure Transmitters
Accuracy (max. error) 0.25 0.5 1.0 1.0 1.0 0.3 1.0 0.5 1.0 1.0
5
Low pressure (up to 40 bar) ü ü ü ü ü ü ü
High pressure (from 40 bar) ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü
Relative pressure ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü
6 Absolute pressure ü
Available as individual units ü ü ü ü ü ü ü
OEM product for large volume
production ü ü ü ü
Flush membrane ü ü ü ü
CANopen Version ü ü
ECE type authorisation
(approved for road vehicles) ü
Approval for potentially
explosive atmospheres ü ü ü ü
Approvals for Shipping ü ü ü ü
E 180.000.2 /11.13
UL Approval ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü
Increased functional safety ü ü
Note:
Not all feature combinations are possible. For precise information, please consult the relevant data sheet.
8
Electronic 2
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4800
3
Description: Technical data:
The pressure transmitter series Input data
HDA 4800 has a very accurate and Measuring ranges 6; 16; 60; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
robust sensor cell with a thin-film Overload pressures 15; 32; 120; 200; 500; 800; 1000 bar
strain gauge on a stainless steel Burst pressures 100; 200; 300; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000 bar
membrane. Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
Outstanding technical specifications Torque value 20 Nm
Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
and robust construction make the Seal: FPM
HDA 4800 particularly suited to
Output data
the field of test rig and diagnostic
Output signal, permitted load resistance 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
technology. It is also suitable for a RLmax.= (UB - 10 V) / 20 mA [kW]
broad range of industrial applications. 0 ..10 V, 3 conductor
Since the accuracy of a pressure RLmin = 2 kW
0 .. 20 mA, 3 conductor source
transmitter varies greatly with RLmax = (UB - 4 V) / 20 mA [kW]
the temperature of the fluid, Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.125 % FS typ.
the instrument has excellent Max. setting ≤ ± 0.25 % FS max.
characteristics in this respect. The Accuracy at min. setting ≤ ± 0.06 % FS typ.
output signals 4 .. 20 mA, 0 .. 10V (B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.125 % FS max.
and 0 .. 20 mA (source) Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.005 % FS / °C typ. 4
Zero point ≤ ± 0.01 % FS / °C max.
are available as standard.
Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.005 % FS / °C typ.
Over range ≤ ± 0.01 % FS / °C max.
Non-linearity at max. setting ≤ ± 0.15 % FS max.
Special features: to DIN 16086
Accuracy ≤ ± 0.125 % FS typ. Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.
Highly robust sensor cell Repeatability ≤ ± 0.05 % FS
Very small temperature error Rise time ≤ 1 ms
Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.1 % FS typ. / year 5
Excellent EMC Environmental conditions
characteristics Compensated temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
Excellent long term stability Operating temperature range1) -40 .. +85 °C / -25 .. +85 °C
Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
Fluid temperature range1) -40 .. +100 °C / -25 .. +100 °C
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4 6
mark2) Certificate No. E318391
Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g
DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65 (for male EN175301-803
(DIN 43650) and Binder 714 M18)
IP 67 (M12x1, when an
IP 67 connector is used)
Other data
Supply voltage 10 .. 30 V DC 2-conductor
12 .. 30 V DC 3 conductor
for use acc. to UL spec. - limited energy - according to
9.3 UL 61010; Class 2;
UL 1310/1585; LPS UL 60950
Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Current consumption ≤ 15 mA
Life expectancy > 10 million cycles
0 .. 100 % FS
Weight ~ 180 g
E 18.380.1/11.13
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and short circuit
protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
B.F.S.L.= Best Fit Straight Line
1)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
2)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No 61010-1
9
Model code: Pin connections:
HDA 4 8 4 X – X – XXX – 000
Binder series 714 M18
Mechanical connection
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
2
Electrical connection
4 = Male, 4 pole Binder series 714 M18
(connector not supplied)
5 = Male, 3 pole+ PE, EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
(connector supplied)
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
(connector not supplied) Pin HDA HDA HDA
Signal 4844-A 4844-B 4844-E
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
B = 0 .. 10 V, 3 conductor 1 n.c. +UB +UB
E = 0 .. 20 mA, 3 conductor 2 Signal+ Signal Signal
Pressure ranges in bar 3 Signal- 0V 0V
006, 016; 060; 100; 250; 400; 600 4 n.c. n.c. n.c.
3 Modification number
000 = Standard EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label
or the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
Pin HDA HDA HDA
4845-A 4845-B 4845-E
1 Signal+ +UB +UB
2 Signal- 0V 0V
3 n.c. Signal Signal
^ Housing Housing Housing
4
Dimensions: M12x1
5 profile seal
ring
6
Binder series 714 -4p male electr. conn.
electr. conn. 1 Signal+ +UB +UB
3p+PE EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
4 pole
2 n.c n.c n.c
3 Signal- 0V 0V
4 n.c Signal Signal
Note:
hex-SW27
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
elastomer
profile seal ring technical department.
DIN3869 Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.380.1/11.13
10
Electronic Pressure 2
Transmitter
HDA 4700
3
Description: Technical data:
The pressure transmitter series Input data
HDA 4700 has a very accurate and Measurement ranges1) 6; 16; 60; 100; 250; 400; 600; 1000 bar
robust sensor cell with a thin-film Overload pressures 15; 32; 120; 200; 500; 800; 1000; 1600 bar
strain gauge on a stainless steel Burst pressures 100; 200; 300; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000; 3000 bar
membrane. Mechanical connection1) G1/4 A DIN 3852;
G1/2 A DIN3852
The 4 .. 20 mA or 0 .. 10 V output Torque value 20 Nm (G1/4); 45 Nm (G1/2)
signals enable connection to all Parts in contact with medium Mech. conn.: Stainless steel
measurement and control devices of Seal: FPM
HYDAC ELECTRONIC GMBH as well Output data
as standard evaluation systems Output signal, permitted load resistance 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
(e.g. PLC controls). RLmax. = (UB - 8 V) / 20 mA [kW]
0 ..10 V, 3 conductor
The main areas of application are RLmin= 2 kW
in the mobile or industrial sectors Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ.
of hydraulics and pneumatics, Max. setting ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
particularly in applications with Accuracy at min. setting ≤ ± 0.15 % FS typ.
restricted installation space. (B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.25 % FS max.
Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.008 % FS / °C typ.
Zero point ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C max. 4
Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.008 % FS / °C typ.
Special features: Over range ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C max.
Accuracy ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ. Non-linearity at max. setting ≤ ± 0.3 % FS max.
Highly robust sensor cell to DIN 16086
Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.
Very small temperature error
Repeatability ≤ ± 0.05 % FS
Excellent EMC characteristics Rise time ≤ 1 ms
Very compact design Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.1 % FS typ. / year
Environmental conditions
Persuasive price / 5
Compensated temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
performance ratio Operating temperature range2) -40 .. +85 °C / -25 .. +85 °C
Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
Fluid temperature range2) -40 .. +100 °C / -25 .. +100 °C
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
mark3) Certificate No. E318391
6
Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g
DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65 (for male EN175301-803
(DIN 43650) and Binder 714 M18)
IP 67 (M12x1, when an
IP 67 connector is used)
Other data
Supply voltage 8 .. 30 V DC 2 conductor
12 .. 30 V DC 3 conductor
for use acc. to UL spec. - limited energy - according to
9.3 UL 61010; Class 2;
UL 1310/1585; LPS UL 60950
Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Current consumption ≤ 25 mA
Life expectancy > 10 million cycles
0 .. 100 % FS
Weight ~ 145 g
E 18.306.6/11.13
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and
short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
B.F.S.L.= Best Fit Straight Line
1)
1000 bar only with mechanical connection G 1/2 A DIN 3852 and vice versa
2)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
3)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No 61010-1
11
Model code: Pin connections:
HDA 4 7 X X – X – XXX – 000
Binder series 714 M18
Mechanical connection
2 = G1/2 A DIN 3852 (only for "1000 bar" press. range)
2 4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
Electrical connection
4 = Male, 4 pole Binder series 714 M18
(connector not supplied)
5 = Male, 3 pole + PE, EN175301-803
(DIN 43650)
(connector supplied)
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole Pin HDA 47X4-A HDA 47X4-B
(connector not supplied)
1 n.c. +UB
Signal
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor 2 Signal+ Signal
B = 0 .. 10 V, 3 conductor 3 Signal- 0V
Pressure ranges in bar 4 n.c. n.c.
3 006; 016; 060; 100; 250; 400; 600
1000 bar (only in conjunction with mechanical connection type "2") EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
Modification number
000 = Standard
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label
or the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure. Pin HDA 47X5-A HDA 47X5-B
1 Signal+ +UB
2 Signal- 0V
Dimensions:
3 n.c. Signal
^ Housing Housing
4
M12x1
elastomer
profile seal ring
Note:
DIN3869 The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
hex. SW27
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.306.6/11.13
elastomer
profile gasket HYDAC electronic GmbH
DIN 3869 Hauptstraße 27, D-66128 Saarbrücken
optional Telephone +49 (0)6897 509-01
O-ring
20.35 x 1.78
Fax +49 (0)6897 509-1726
E-mail: [email protected]
Internet: www.hydac.com
12
Electronic 2
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4700
with Approvals for Shipping
3
Description: Technical data:
This pressure transmitter has been Input data
specially developed for shipbuilding Measurement ranges 6; 16; 40; 60; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
applications and is based on the Overload pressures 15; 32; 80; 120; 200; 500; 800; 1000 bar
HDA 4000 series.
Burst pressures 100; 200; 200; 300; 500; 1 000; 2000; 2000 bar
With its stainless steel measurement Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
cell and thin-film strain gauge, Torque value 20 Nm
the HDA 4700 is designed to measure
Parts in contact with medium Mech. conn.: Stainless steel
relative pressures in the high Seal: FPM
pressure range.
Output data
The evaluation electronics converts
the measured pressure into a Output signal, permitted load resistance 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
RLmax = (UB - 10 V) / 20 mA [kW]
proportional analogue signal of
4 .. 20 mA. Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ.
Max. setting ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
The electronic module is completely Accuracy at min. setting ≤ ± 0.15 % FS typ.
potted to protect it against humidity, (B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.25 % FS max.
vibrations and shock, and is enclosed Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.008 % FS / °C typ.
in a solid stainless steel housing. Zero point ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C max. 4
For use in the shipping industry, Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.008 % FS / °C typ.
these pressure transmitters have Range ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C max.
been approved by the following Non-linearity at max. setting ≤ ± 0.3 % FS max.
organisations. to DIN 16086
Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.
Repeatability ≤ ± 0.05 % FS
Rise time ≤ 1 ms
Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.1 % FS typ. / year 5
Environmental conditions
Approvals: Compensated temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
American Bureau Operating temperature range1) -40 .. +85 °C / -25 .. +85 °C
of Shipping Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
Fluid temperature range1) -40 .. +100 °C / -25 .. +100 °C
6
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Lloyds Register
Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g
of Shipping DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65 (for male EN175301-803 (DIN 43650))
IP 67 (for M12x1 male, when an
IP 67 connector female is used)
Det Norske Veritas
Other data
Supply voltage 10 .. 32 V DC
Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Life expectancy > 10 million cycles
Germanischer Lloyd
0 .. 100 % FS
Weight ~ 150 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and
short circuit protection are provided.
Bureau Veritas FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
B.F.S.L.= Best Fit Straight Line
E 18.322.2/11.13
1)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
4
Dimensions:
Note:
hex.-SW27
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
elastomer
profile seal ring technical department.
DIN3869 Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.322.2/11.13
14
Electronic 2
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4700
CANopen
3
Description: Technical data:
The HDA 4700 CAN is a digital Input data
pressure transmitter which is used Measuring ranges1) 40; 100; 250; 400; 600; 1000 bar
to measure relative pressures in Overload pressures 80; 200; 500; 800; 1000; 1600 bar
hydraulics and pneumatics. The Burst pressures 200; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000; 3000 bar
measured pressure value is digitized Mechanical connection1) G1/4 A DIN 3852; G1/2 A DIN 3852
and made available to the CAN Torque value 20 Nm (G1/4); 45 Nm (G1/2)
field bus system via the CANopen Parts in contact with medium Mech. conn.: Stainless steel
Seal: FPM
protocol. The instrument parameters
Output data
can be viewed and configured by the Output signal CANopen protocol
user via the CANopen object directory Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ.
using standard CAN software. Max. setting ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
This pressure transmitter, which is Accuracy at min. setting ≤ ± 0.15 % FS typ.
based on the HDA 4700, has a very (B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.25 % FS max.
Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.008 % FS / °C typ.
accurate and robust sensor cell with Zero point ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C max.
a thin-film strain gauge on a stainless Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.008 % FS / °C typ.
steel membrane. Over range ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C max.
Due to their outstanding temperature Non-linearity at max. setting ≤ ± 0.3 % FS max.
and EMC characteristics, together to DIN 16086 4
Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.
with their compact dimensions, these
Repeatability ≤ ± 0.08 % FS
instruments can be used in a wide
Rise time ≤ 1 ms
range of applications in the mobile Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.1 % FS typ. / year
and industrial sectors. Environmental conditions
Compensated temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
Operating temperature range2) -40 .. +85 °C / -25 .. +85 °C
Special features: Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
CANopen interface Fluid temperature range2) -40 .. +100 °C / -25 .. +100 °C 5
Accuracy ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ. mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Robust thin-film cell mark3) Certificate No. E318391
Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g
Excellent EMC characteristics DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Very compact design Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 67
Other data 6
Supply voltage 10 .. 35 V DC
for use acc. to UL spec. - limited energy - according to
9.3 UL 61010; Class 2;
UL 1310/1585; LPS UL 60950
Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Current consumption ≤ 25 mA
Life expectancy > 10 million cycles
0 .. 100 % FS
Weight approx. 150 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage and
excess voltage protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
B.F.S.L.= Best Fit Straight Line
Special models available on request.
1)
1000 bar only with mechanical connection G1/2 A DIN 3852 and vice versa
2)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
3)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No 61010-1
E 18.316.3/11.13
15
Model code: Pin connections:
HDA 4 7 X 8 – K – XXXX – 000
M12x1
Mechanical connection
2 = G1/2 A DIN 3852 (only for "1000 bar" press. range)
2 4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male) 4 3
5
Electrical connection
8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole 1 2
(connector not supplied)
Signal
K = CANopen
Pressure ranges in bar
Pin Signal Description
0040; 0100; 0250; 0400; 0600
1000 (only in conjunction with mechanical connection type "2") 1 Housing shield/housing
Modification number 2 +UB supply +
000 = Standard (Baud Rate: 250k Node Id: 1) 3 0V supply -
Note:
4 CAN_H bus line dominant high
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or
3 the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument. 5 CAN_L bus line dominant low
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
Dimensions:
male electr. conn.
5 pole
6
hex. SW27
elastomer
profile gasket
DIN 3869 Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.316.3/11.13
elastomer
profile gasket HYDAC electronic GmbH
DIN 3869 Hauptstraße 27, D-66128 Saarbrücken
optional Telephone +49 (0)6897 509-01
O-ring Fax +49 (0)6897 509-1726
20.35 x 1.78
E-mail: [email protected]
Internet: www.hydac.com
16
Electronic Pressure 2
Transmitter
HDA 4400
3
Description: Technical data:
The pressure transmitter series Input data
HDA 4400 has a pressure Measuring ranges1) 16; 60; 100; 250; 400; 600; 1000 bar
measurement cell with thin-film strain Overload pressures 32; 120; 200; 500; 800; 1000; 1600 bar
gauge on a stainless steel membrane. Burst pressures 200; 300; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000; 3000 bar
Mechanical connection1) G1/4 A DIN 3852; G1/2 A DIN 3852
The 4 .. 20 V or 0 .. 10 V output
Torque value 20 Nm (G1/4); 45 Nm (G1/2)
signals enable connection to all
Parts in contact with medium Mech. conn.: Stainless steel
HYDAC ELECTRONIC GMBH Seal: FPM
measurement and control devices Output data
as well as connection to standard Output signal, permitted load resistance 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
evaluation systems (e.g. PLC RLmax. = (UB - 8 V) / 20 mA [kW]
controls). 0 ..10 V, 3 conductor
RLmin. = 2 kW
The main areas of application are Accuracy to DIN 16086 ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
in the mobile or industrial sectors Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
of hydraulics and pneumatics, Accuracy at min. setting ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ.
particularly in applications with (B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
restricted installation space. Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C typ.
Zero point ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max.
Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C typ. 4
Over range ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max.
Special features: Non-linearity at max. setting ≤ ± 0.3 % FS max.
Accuracy ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ. to DIN 16086
Highly robust sensor cell Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.4 % FS max.
Very small temperature error Repeatability ≤ ± 0.1 % FS
Rise time ≤ 1 ms
Excellent EMC characteristics Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
Very compact design Environmental conditions
Compensated temperature range -25 .. +85 °C 5
Persuasive price /
Operating temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
performance ratio
Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
Fluid temperature range2) -40 .. +100 °C / -25 .. +100 °C
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
mark3) Certificate No. E318391
Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g 6
DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65 (for male EN175301-803
(DIN 43650) and Binder 714 M18)
IP 67 (for M12x1, when an
IP 67 connector is used)
Other data
Supply voltage 8 .. 30 V DC, 2 conductor
12 .. 30 V DC, 3 conductor
for use acc. to UL spec. - limited energy - according to
9.3 UL 61010; Class 2;
UL 1310/1585; LPS UL 60950
Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Current consumption ≤ 25 mA
Life expectancy > 10 million cycles
0 .. 100 % FS
Weight ~ 145 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and
E 18.305.4/11.13
17
Model code: Pin connections:
HDA 4 4 X X – X – XXX – 000
Binder series 714 M18
Mechanical connection
2 = G1/2 A DIN 3852 (only for "1000 bar" press. range)
2 4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
Electrical connection
4 = Male, 4 pole Binder series 714 M18
(connector not supplied)
5 = Male, 3 pole + PE, EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
(connector supplied)
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
(connector not supplied) Pin HDA 44X4-A HDA 44X4-B
Signal 1 n.c. +UB
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
B = 0 .. 10 V, 3 conductor 2 Signal+ Signal
3 Signal- 0V
Pressure ranges in bar
016; 060; 100; 250; 400; 600 4 n.c. n.c.
3 1000 bar (only in conjunction with mechanical connection type "2")
Modification number EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
000 = Standard
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
Pin HDA 44X5-A HDA 44X5-B
1 Signal+ +UB
2 Signal- 0V
Dimensions:
3 n.c. Signal
^ Housing Housing
4
M12x1
elastomer
profile seal ring
Note:
DIN3869 The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
hex. SW27
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.305.4/11.13
elastomer
profile gasket HYDAC electronic GmbH
DIN 3869 Hauptstraße 27, D-66128 Saarbrücken
Optional Telephone +49 (0)6897 509-01
O-ring
20.35 x 1.78
Fax +49 (0)6897 509-1726
E-mail: [email protected]
Internet: www.hydac.com
18
Electronic 2
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4400
with Approvals for Shipping
3
Description: Technical data:
This pressure transmitter has been Input data
specially developed for shipbuilding Measuring ranges 6; 16; 40; 60; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
applications and is based on the Overload pressures 15; 32; 80; 120; 200; 500; 800; 1000 bar
HDA 4000 series.
Burst pressures 100; 200; 200; 300; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000 bar
With its stainless steel measurement
Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
cell and thin-film strain gauge,
the HDA 4400 is designed to measure Torque value 20 Nm
relative pressures in the high Parts in contact with medium Mech. connector: Stainless steel
pressure range. Seal: FPM
The evaluation electronics converts Output data
the measured pressure into a Output signal, permitted load resistance 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
proportional analogue signal of RLmax.= (UB - 10 V) / 20 mA [kW]
4 .. 20 mA. Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
The electronic module is completely Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
potted to protect it against humidity, Accuracy at min. setting ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ.
vibrations and shock, and is enclosed (B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
in a solid stainless steel housing. Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C typ.
Zero point ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. 4
For use in the shipping industry,
Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C typ.
these pressure transmitters have Range ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max.
been approved by the following
Non-linearity at max. setting ≤ ± 0.3 % FS max.
organisations.
to DIN 16086
Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.4 % FS max.
Repeatability ≤ ± 0.1 % FS
Rise time ≤ 1 ms
Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year 5
Environmental conditions
Approvals: Compensated temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
American Bureau Operating temperature range1) -40 .. +85 °C / -25 .. +85 °C
of Shipping Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
Fluid temperature range1) -40 .. +100 °C / -25 .. +100 °C
6
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Lloyds Register
Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g
of Shipping DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65 (for male EN175301-803
(DIN 43650))
IP 67 (for M12x1 male when
Det Norske Veritas
an IP 67 connector is used
Other data
Supply voltage 10 .. 32 V DC
Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Germanischer Lloyd
Life expectancy > 10 million cycles
0 .. 100 % FS
Weight ~ 150 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and
Bureau Veritas short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
E 18.317.3/11.13
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
4
Dimensions:
Note:
hex.-SW27
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
elastomer
not described, please contact the relevant
profile seal technical department.
ring DIN3869 Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.317.3/11.13
20
Electronic Pressure 2
Transmitter
HDA 4300
3
Description: Technical data:
The pressure transmitter series Input data
HDA 4300 has a ceramic pressure Measuring ranges 1; 2.5; 4; 6; 10; 16; 25; 40 bar
measurement cell with a thick-film -1 .. 5; -1 .. 9 bar
strain gauge which has been specially Overload pressures 3; 8; 12; 20; 32; 50; 80; 120 bar
20; 32 bar
developed for measuring relative
Burst pressures 5; 12; 18; 30; 48; 75; 120; 180 bar
pressure in the low pressure range. 30; 48 bar
The output signals 4 .. 20 mA or Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852; G1/2 B DIN-EN 837
0 .. 10 V allow connection of all Torque value 20 Nm (G1/4); 45 Nm (G1/2)
HYDAC ELECTRONIC GMBH Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
measurement and control devices as Sensor cell: Ceramic
Seal: Copper (G1/2) / FPM / EPDM
well as industry standard control and (as per model code)
monitoring instruments. Output data
The main areas of application Output signal, permitted load resistance 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
are low-pressure applications RLmax. = (UB - 8 V) / 20 mA [kW]
0 ..10 V, 3 conductor
in hydraulics and pneumatics, RLmin = 2 kW
particularly in refrigeration and air- Accuracy to DIN 16086 ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
conditioning technology, the food and Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
pharmaceutical industries. 4
Accuracy at min. setting ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ.
(B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.02 % FS / °C typ.
Special features: Zero point ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max.
Accuracy ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ. Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.02 % FS / °C typ.
Over range ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max.
Very small temperature error Non-linearity at max. setting ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
Excellent EMC characteristics to DIN 16086
Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.4 % FS max.
Very compact design Repeatability ≤ ± 0.1 % FS 5
Persuasive price / Rise time ≤ 1 ms
performance ratio Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
Environmental conditions
Compensated temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
Operating temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C 6
Fluid temperature range1) -40 .. +100 °C / -25 .. +100 °C
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
mark2) Certificate No. E318391
Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g
DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65 (for male EN175301-803
(DIN 43650) and Binder 714 M18)
IP 67 (M12x1, when an IP 67 connector is used)
Other data
Supply voltage 8 .. 30 V DC 2 conductor
12 .. 30 V DC 3 conductor
for use acc. to UL spec. - limited energy - according to
9.3 UL 61010; Class 2;
UL 1310/1585; LPS UL 60950
Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Current consumption ≤ 25 mA
Life expectancy > 10 million cycles, 0 .. 100 % FS
E 18.323.2/11.13
Weight ~ 150 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override
and short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
B.F.S.L.= Best Fit Straight Line
1)
-25 °C with FPM or EDPM seal, -40 °C on request
2)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No 61010-1 21
Model code: Pin connections:
HDA 4 3 X X – X – XXXX – 000 – X 1
Binder series 714 M18
Mechanical connection
1 = G1/2 B DIN-EN 837 (male)
2 4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
Electrical connection
4 = Male, 4 pole Binder series 714 M18
(connector not supplied)
5 = Male, 3 pole + PE,
DIN EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
(connector supplied)
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole, Pin HDA 43X4-A HDA 43X4-B
(connector not supplied)
1 n.c. +UB
Signal
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor 2 Signal+ Signal
B = 0 .. 10 V, 3 conductor 3 Signal- 0V
Pressure ranges in bar 4 n.c. n.c.
3 01.0; 02.5; 04.0; 06.0; 0010; 0016; 0025; 0040
0005 (-1 .. 5); 0009 (-1 .. 9) EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
Modification number
000 = Standard
Seal material (in contact with fluid)
F = FPM seal (e.g.: for hydraulic oils)
E = EPDM seal (e.g.: for refrigerants)
Material of connection (in contact with fluid)
1 = Stainless steel
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the Pin HDA 43X5-A HDA 43X5-B
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
1 Signal+ +UB
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors can be found 2 Signal- 0V
in the Accessories brochure. 3 n.c. Signal
^ Housing Housing
4
Dimensions: M12x1
6
Binder series 714 -4 pole male electr. conn.
3p+PE EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
male electr. conn. 2 n.c. n.c.
4 pole
3 Signal- 0V
4 n.c. Signal
Note:
hex.-SW27 hex.-SW27
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
elastomer
profile seal ring technical department.
DIN3869 Subject to technical modifications.
flat seal ring Cu
E 18.323.2/11.13
22
Electronic 2
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4300
with Approvals for Shipping
3
Description: Technical data:
This pressure transmitter has been Input data
specially developed for shipbuilding Measuring ranges 1; 2.5; 4; 6; 10; 16; 25; 40 bar
applications and is based on the -1 .. 5; -1 .. 9 bar
HDA 4000 series. Overload pressures 3; 8; 12; 20; 32; 50; 80; 120 bar
The HDA 4300 has a ceramic 20; 32 bar
measurement cell with thick-film Burst pressures 5; 12; 18; 30; 48; 75; 120; 180 bar
strain gauge for measuring relative 30; 48 bar
pressure in the low pressure range. Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
The evaluation electronics converts Torque value 20 Nm
the measured pressure into a Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
proportional analogue signal of Sensor cell: Ceramic
4 .. 20 mA. Seal: FPM / EPDM
(as per model code)
The electronic module is completely
Output data
potted to protect it against humidity,
vibrations and shock, and is enclosed Output signal, permitted load resistance 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
RLmax.= (UB - 10 V) / 20 mA [kW]
in a solid stainless steel housing.
Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
For use in the shipping industry, Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max. 4
these pressure transmitters have Accuracy at min. setting ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ.
been approved by the following (B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
organisations. Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.02 % FS / °C typ.
Zero point ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max.
Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.02 % FS / °C typ.
Over range ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max.
Non-linearity at max. setting ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
to DIN 16086
Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.4 % FS max. 5
Approvals: Repeatability ≤ ± 0.1 % FS
Rise time ≤ 1 ms
American Bureau
Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
of Shipping
Environmental conditions
Compensated temperature range -25 .. +85 °C 6
Operating temperature range1) -30 .. +85°C / -25 .. +85 °C
Lloyds Register
Storage temperature range -30 .. +100 °C
of Shipping
Fluid temperature range1) -30 .. +100 °C / -25 .. +100 °C
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g
Det Norske Veritas
DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65 (for male EN175301-803
(DIN 43650))
IP 67 (for M12x1 male, when an IP 67
connector is used)
Germanischer Lloyd
Other data
Supply voltage 10 .. 32 V DC
Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Life expectancy > 10 million cycles
Bureau Veritas
0 .. 100 % FS
E 18.324.2/11.13
Weight ~ 150 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and
short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
Other approvals on request B.F.S.L.= Best Fit Straight Line
1)
-25 °C with FPM or EPDM seal, -30 °C on request
23
Model code: Pin connections:
HDA 4 3 4 X – A – XXXX – S00 – X 1
EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
Mechanical connection
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
2
Electrical connection
5 = Male, 3 pole + PE,
EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
(connector supplied)
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
(connector not supplied)
Signal
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor Pin HDA 4345-A
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label
or the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
4
Dimensions:
Note:
hex.-SW27
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
elastomer
profile seal ring technical department.
DIN3869 Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.324.2/11.13
24
Electronic Pressure 2
Transmitter
HDA 4100
3
Description: Technical data:
The pressure transmitter series Input data
HDA 4100 has a ceramic pressure Measuring ranges 1; 2.5 bar
measurement cell with thick-film Overload pressures 3; 8 bar
strain gauge which has been specially Burst pressures 5; 12 bar
developed for measuring absolute Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852; G1/2 B DIN-EN 837
pressure in the low-pressure range. Torque value 20 Nm (G1/4); 45 Nm (G1/2)
Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
The 4 .. 20 mA or 0 .. 10 V output Sensor cell: Ceramic
signals enable connection to all Seal: Copper (G1/2) / FPM / EPDM
HYDAC ELECTRONIC GMBH (as per model code)
measurement and control devices Output data
as well as standard control and Output signal, permitted load resistance 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
RLmax. = (UB - 8 V) / 20 mA [kW]
evaluation systems. 0 ..10 V, 3 conductor
The main areas of application RLmin. = 2 kW
are low-pressure applications Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
in hydraulics and pneumatics, Max. setting ≤ ± 1.0 % FS max.
particularly in refrigeration and air- Accuracy at min. setting ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ.
(B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
conditioning technology, the food and Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.02 % FS / °C typ.
pharmaceutical industries. 4
Zero point ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max.
Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.02 % FS / °C typ.
Over range ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max.
Special features: Non-linearity at max. setting ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
Accuracy ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ. to DIN 16086
Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.4 % FS max.
Very small temperature error
Repeatability ≤ ± 0.1 % FS
Excellent EMC characteristics Rise time ≤ 1 ms
Very compact design Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
Environmental conditions 5
Persuasive price /
Compensated temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
performance ratio Operating temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
Fluid temperature range1) -40 .. +100 °C / -25 .. +100 °C
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
mark2) Certificate No. E318391 6
Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g
DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65 (for male EN175301-803
(DIN 43650) and Binder 714 M18)
IP 67 (for M12x1, when an
IP 67 connector is used)
Other data
Supply voltage 8 .. 30 V DC 2 conductor
12 .. 30 V DC 3 conductor
for use acc. to UL spec. - limited energy - according to
9.3 UL 61010; Class 2;
UL 1310/1585; LPS UL 60950
Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Current consumption ≤ 25 mA
Life expectancy > 10 million cycles
0 .. 100 % FS
Weight ~ 145 g
E 18.314.3/11.13
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and
short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
B.F.S.L.= Best Fit Straight Line
1)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
2)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No 61010-1
25
Model code: Pin connections:
HDA 4 1 X X – X – XXXX – 000 – X 1
Binder series 714 M18
Mechanical connection
1 = G1/2 B DIN-EN 837 (male)
2 4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
Electrical connection
4 = Male, 4 pole Binder series 714 M18
(connector not supplied)
5 = Male, 3 pole + PE,
EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
(connector supplied)
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole Pin HDA 41X4-A HDA 41X4-B
(connector not supplied)
1 n.c. +UB
Signal
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor 2 Signal+ Signal
B = 0 .. 10 V, 3 conductor 3 Signal- 0V
Pressure ranges in bar 4 n.c. n.c.
3 01.0; 02.5
Modification number EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
000 = Standard
Seal material (in contact with fluid)
F = FPM seal (e.g.: for hydraulic oils)
E = EPDM seal (e.g.: for refrigerants)
Material of connection (in contact with fluid)
1 = Stainless steel
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument. Pin HDA 41X5-A HDA 41X5-B
Accessories: 1 Signal+ +UB
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors can be found
in the Accessories brochure. 2 Signal- 0V
3 n.c. Signal
^ Housing Housing
4
Dimensions: M12x1
6
Binder series 714 -4 pole male electr. conn.
3pole+PE EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
male electr. conn. 2 n.c. n.c.
4 pole
3 Signal- 0V
4 n.c. Signal
Note:
hex.-SW27 hex.-SW27
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
elastomer
profile seal ring technical department.
DIN3869 Subject to technical modifications.
flat seal ring Cu
E 18.314.3/11.13
26
Electronic 2
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4100
with Approvals for Shipping
3
Description: Technical data:
This pressure transmitter has been Input data
specially developed for shipbuilding Measuring ranges 1; 2.5 bar
applications and is based on the Overload pressures 3; 8 bar
HDA 4000 series. Burst pressures 5; 12 bar
The HDA 4100 has a ceramic Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
measurement cell with thick-film Torque value 20 Nm
strain gauge for measuring absolute Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
pressure in the low pressure range. Sensor cell: Ceramic
The evaluation electronics converts Seal: FPM / EPDM
the measured pressure into a (as per model code)
proportional analogue signal of Output data
4 .. 20 mA. Output signal, permitted load resistance 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
RLmax.= (UB - 10 V) / 20 mA [kW]
The electronic module is completely
potted to protect it against humidity, Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
vibrations and shock, and is enclosed
Accuracy at min. setting ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ.
in a solid stainless steel housing. (B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
For use in the shipping industry, Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.02 % FS / °C typ. 4
these pressure transmitters have Zero point ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max.
been approved by the following Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.02 % FS / °C typ.
organisations. Over range ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max.
Non-linearity at max. setting ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
to DIN 16086
Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.25 % FS max.
Repeatability ≤ ± 0.1 % FS
Rise time ≤ 1 ms
5
Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
Approvals: Environmental conditions
American Bureau Compensated temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
of Shipping Operating temperature range1) -30 .. +85 °C / -25 .. +85 °C
Storage temperature range -30 .. +100 °C
Fluid temperature range1) -30 .. +85 °C / -25 .. +85 °C 6
Lloyds Register
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
of Shipping Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g
DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65 (for male EN175301-803
(DIN 43650))
Det Norske Veritas
IP 67 (for M12x1 male, when an
IP 67 connector is used)
Other data
Supply voltage 10 .. 32 V DC
Germanischer Lloyd
Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Life expectancy > 10 million cycles
0 .. 100 % FS
Weight ~ 150 g
Bureau Veritas Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and
short circuit protection are provided.
E 18.325.2/11.13
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label
or the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors can be found Pin HDA 4146-A
in the Accessories brochure. 1 Signal+
2 n.c.
3 Signal-
4 n.c.
4
Dimensions:
Note:
hex.-SW27
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
elastomer
profile seal ring technical department.
DIN3869 Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.325.2/11.13
28
Electronic Pressure 2
Transmitter
HDA 7446
3
Description: Technical data:
The pressure transmitter series Input data
HDA 7400 combines excellent Measuring ranges 40; 60; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
technical specifications with a highly Overload pressures 80; 120; 200; 500; 800; 1000 bar
compact design. Burst pressures 200; 300; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000 bar
The HDA 7446 was specifically Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
developed for OEM applications e.g. Torque value 20 Nm
Parts in contact with medium Mech. conn.: Stainless steel
in mobile applications. Seal: FPM
A strain gauge sensor cell is the
Output data
basis for a robust, long-life pressure
Output signal, permitted load resistance 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
transmitter. RLmax. = (UB - 8 V) / 20 mA [kW]
Various pressure ranges between 0 ..10 V, 3 conductor
0 .. 40 bar and 0 .. 600 bar provide RLmin. = 2 kW
versatility when adapting to particular Accuracy to DIN 16086 ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
applications. Accuracy at min. setting ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ.
For integration into modern controls (B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
(e.g. with PLC), the analogue output Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C typ.
signals 4 .. 20 mA or 0 .. 10V are also Zero point ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max.
Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C typ. 4
available on the standard version.
Over range ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max.
Other output signals are available on Non-linearity at max. setting ≤ ± 0.3 % FS max.
request. to DIN 16086
Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.4 % FS max.
Repeatability ≤ ± 0.1 % FS
Special features: Rise time ≤ 2 ms
Accuracy ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ. Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
Highly robust sensor cell Environmental conditions
Compensated temperature range -25 .. +85 °C 5
Very compact design
Operating temperature range1) -40 .. +85 °C /-25 ... +85 °C
Very small temperature error Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
Excellent EMC characteristics Fluid temperature range1) -40 .. +100 °C / -25 .. +100 °C
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Excellent durability -mark2) Certificate No. E318391
Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g 6
DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 67 (for M12x1, when an IP 67
connector is used)
Other data
Supply voltage 8 .. 30 V DC 2 conductor
12 .. 30 V DC 3 conductor
for use acc. to UL spec. - limited energy - according to
9.3 UL 61010; Class 2;
UL 1310/1585; LPS UL 60950
Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Current consumption ≤ 25 mA
Life expectancy > 10 million cycles
0 .. 100 % FS
Weight ~ 60 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and
short circuit protection are provided.
E 18.326.2/11.13
29
Model code: Pin connections:
HDA 7 4 4 6 – X – XXX – 000
M12x1
Mechanical connection
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
2
Electrical connection
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
(connector not supplied)
Signal
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
B = 0 .. 10 V, 3 conductor
Pressure ranges in bar Pin HDA 7446-A HDA 7446-B
040; 060; 100; 250; 400; 600
1 Signal+ +UB
Modification number 2 n.c. n.c.
000 = Standard
3 Signal- 0V
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
4
Dimensions:
hex.-SW27
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.326.2/11.13
30
Electronic 2
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 7400
CANopen
3
Description: Technical data:
The HDA 7400 CAN is a digital Input data
pressure transmitter which is used Measuring ranges 40; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
to measure relative pressures in Overload pressures 80; 200; 500; 800; 1000 bar
hydraulics and pneumatics. The Burst pressures 200; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000 bar
measured pressure value is digitized Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
and made available to the CAN Torque value 20 Nm
field bus system via the CANopen Parts in contact with medium Mech. conn.: Stainless steel
protocol. The instrument parameters Seal: FPM
can be viewed and configured by the Output data
user via the CANopen object directory Output signal CANopen protocol
using standard CAN software. Accuracy to DIN 16086 ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
This pressure transmitter, which is Accuracy at min. setting ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ.
based on the HDA 7400, has a very (B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
accurate and robust sensor cell with Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C typ.
a thin-film strain gauge on a stainless Zero point ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max.
steel membrane. Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C typ.
Over range ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max.
Due to their outstanding temperature Non-linearity at max. setting ≤ ± 0.3 % FS max.
and EMC characteristics, together to DIN 16086
4
with their compact dimensions, these Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.4 % FS max.
instruments can be used in a wide Repeatability ≤ ± 0.1 % FS
range of applications in the mobile Rise time ≤ 2 ms
and industrial sectors. Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
Environmental conditions
Compensated temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
Special features: Operating temperature range1) -40 .. +85 °C / -25 .. +85 °C
CANopen interface Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C 5
Fluid temperature range1) -40 .. +100 °C / -25 .. +100 °C
Accuracy ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Robust thin-film cell mark2) Certificate No. E318391
Excellent EMC characteristics Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g
DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Very compact design Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 67
6
Other data
Supply voltage 10 .. 35 V DC
for use acc. to UL spec. - limited energy - according to
9.3 UL 61010; Class 2;
UL 1310/1585; LPS UL 60950
Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Current consumption ≤ 25 mA
Life expectancy > 10 million cycles
0 .. 100 % FS
Weight ~ 60 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage and excess voltage protection
are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
B.F.S.L.= Best Fit Straight Line
1)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
2)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No 61010-1
E 18.367.2/11.13
31
Model code: Pin connections:
HDA 7 4 4 8 – K – XXXX – 000
M12x1
Mechanical connection
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
2 4 3
Electrical connection 5
8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole
(connector not supplied) 1 2
Signal
K = CANopen
Pressure ranges in bar
0040; 0100; 0250; 0400; 0600 Pin Signal Description
Modification number 1 Housing shield/housing
000 = Standard (Baud Rate: 250k Node Id: 1) 2 +UB supply +
Note: 3 0V supply -
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or 4 CAN_H bus line dominant high
the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
3 5 CAN_L bus line dominant low
Accessories: Configuration corresp. to CIA-DR-303-1
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
Dimensions:
Note:
hex.-SW27 The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
elastomer
profile seal ring described.
DIN3869 For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.367.2/11.13
32
Electronic 2
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 3800
for Iron & Steel Works Applications
3
Description: Technical data:
This high-precision pressure Input data
transmitter was specially developed Measurement ranges1) 16; 60; 100; 150; 250; 300; 350;
and adapted for the sophisticated 400; 500; 600 bar
measurement demands of steelworks Overload pressures 32; 120; 200; 500; 800; 900; 900;
technology. 900; 900; 1000 bar
The instrument has a very robust Burst pressures 200; 300; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000; 2000;
sensor cell with a thin-film strain 2000; 2000; 2000 bar
gauge on a stainless steel membrane. Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
Its outstanding specifications G1/2 A DIN 3852
in respect of temperature effect Torque value 20 Nm (G1/4 A)
(temperature drift for zero point and 45 Nm (G1/2 A)
range are in each case max. Parts in contact with medium Mech. conn.: Stainless steel
≤ ± 0.01 % FS / °C) and accuracy Seal: FPM (G1/4 A)
NBR O-ring (G1/2 A)
(≤ ± 0.15 % FS typ.) make it ideally
suited for use in the environmental Output data
conditions found in steelworks. Output signal, permitted load resistance 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
RLmax.= (UB - 10 V) / 20 mA [kW]
The excellent EMC characteristics 0 .. 20 mA, (3 conductor rising)
guarantee signal stability during the 4
RLmax.= (UB - 10 V) / 20 mA [kW]
harshest high-frequency, electro- Accuracy to DIN 16086 ≤ ± 0.15 % FS typ.
magnetic interference. Max. setting ≤ ± 0.3 % FS max.
Accuracy at min. setting ≤ ± 0.1 % FS typ.
(B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.15 % FS max.
Special features: Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.005 % FS / °C typ.
Accuracy ≤ ± 0.15 % FS typ. Zero point ≤ ± 0.01 % FS / °C max.
Specially designed for use in Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.005 % FS / °C typ.
steelworks and rolling mills Over range ≤ ± 0.01 % FS / °C max. 5
Highly robust sensor cell Non-linearity at max. setting ≤ ± 0.2 % FS max.
to DIN 16086 (from 100 bar ≤ ± 0.15 % FS max.)
Very small temperature error
Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.
Excellent EMC characteristics Repeatability ≤ ± 0.05 % FS
Excellent long term stability Rise time ≤ 1.5 ms
6
Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.1 % FS typ. / year
Environmental conditions
Compensated temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
Operating temperature range2) -40 .. +85°C / -25 .. +85 °C
Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
Fluid temperature range2) -40 .. +100 °C / -25 .. +100 °C
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Vibration resistance to ≤ 25 g
DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 68
Other data
Supply voltage 2 conductor 10 .. 30 V DC
Supply voltage 3 conductor 12 .. 30 V DC
Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Current consumption 3 conductor approx. 25 mA
E 18.304.5/11.13
4
Dimensions:
length as per
model code
cable gland
PG 7
hex.-SW27
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
elastomer
profile seal ring
the operating conditions and applications
DIN3869 described.
hex.- For applications or operating conditions
SW27 not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.304.5/11.13
34
E 18.304.5/11.13
35
6
5
4
3
2
Electronic Pressure Switches
Electronic pressure switches for general applications: Electronic pressure switches offer a
Page multitude of advantages in comparison
EDS 3400 37 to mechanical pressure switches and
EDS 3400 Menu navigation according to VDMA 41 contact pressure gauges.
EDS 3400 IO-Link 43 Their superiority is shown through
EDS 3300 45 greater accuracy, freedom from wear,
EDS 3300 Menu navigation according to VDMA 49 long-term stability, simpler operation and
EDS 3300 IO-Link 51 the high number of switching cycles,
EDS 3100 53 among other things.
EDS 3100 Menu navigation according to VDMA 57
EDS 3100 IO-Link 59
EDS 300 61
EDS 300 Approvals for shipping 65
EDS 8000 67
EDS 601 69
EDS 1700 71
EDS 4400 Programmable 73
3 EDS 4300 Programmable 75
EDS 820 IO-Link 77
Further electronic pressure switches for special applications can be found in the Sections
"Pressure Sensors with Flush Membrane", "Sensors for Potentially Explosive Atmosphe-
res" and "OEM Products for Large Volume Production" .
EDS 3400
EDS 3300
EDS 3100
EDS 8000
EDS 1700
EDS 4400
EDS 4300
EDS 4100
EDS 300
EDS 601
EDS 820
EDS 810
EDS 710
EDS 410
Electronic
Pressure Switches
Accuracy (max. error) 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 0.5 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0
Low pressure (up to 40 bar) ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü
High pressure (from 40 bar) ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü
Relative pressure ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü
Absolute pressure ü ü
Number of switching outputs 2 2 2 2 2 2 4 2 2 2 2 2 1 2
Analogue output ü ü ü ü ü ü
Digital display ü ü ü ü ü ü ü
Programmable ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü
Factory-set
(not field-adjustable) ü ü ü ü ü ü
DESINA-compliant ü ü ü
VDMA Menu Navigation ü ü ü ü
Available as individual units ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü
OEM product for large
volume production ü ü ü ü ü ü
Flush membrane ü ü
IO Link Interface ü ü ü ü
ECE type authorisation
(approved for road vehicles) ü
Approval for potentially
explosive atmospheres ü ü ü
E 180.000.2 /11.13
36
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 3400
3
Description: Technical data:
The EDS 3400 is a compact electronic Input data
pressure switch with integrated Measuring ranges 40; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
digital display for relative pressure Overload pressures 80; 200; 500; 800; 1000; bar
measurement in the high-pressure Burst pressures 200; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000 bar
range. The instrument has a stainless Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
steel measurement cell with thin-film Threaded port DIN 3852-G1/4
strain gauge. The instrument can have Torque value 20 Nm
one or two switching outputs and there Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
is the option of an additional switchable Seal: FPM (G1/4 A DIN 3852)
analogue output signal (4 .. 20 mA Output data
or 0 .. 10 V). Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
A special design feature of the Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
(display, analogue output)
EDS 3400 is that the display can be
Repeatability ≤ ± 0.25 % FS max.
moved in two planes. The device can be
Temperature drift ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. zero point
installed in almost any position and the ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. range
display can be turned to the optimum Analogue output (optional)
position without the usual additional Signal selectable:
expense of a mechanical adapter. The 4 .. 20 mA load resistance max. 500 W
4-digit display can indicate the pressure 0 .. 10 V load resistance min. 1 kW
in bar, psi or MPa. Switch outputs
The user can select the particular Type PNP transistor output
unit of measurement. When changing Switching current max. 1.2 A
to a different measurement unit, the Switching cycles > 100 million
instrument automatically converts all Reaction time < 10 ms
the switching settings to the new unit of Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
measurement. In addition, the DESINA® diagnostic signal (Pin 2)
EDS 3400 is also available in a Function OK: HIGH level / not OK: LOW level
DESINA®-compliant version. Level HIGH: approx. +UB / LOW: < +0.3 V
The main applications of the Environmental conditions
EDS 3400 are primarily in hydraulics Compensated temperature range -10 .. +70 °C
and pneumatics, as well as in Operating temperature range -25 .. +80 °C (-25 .. +60 °C acc. to UL spec.)
refrigeration and air conditioning Storage temperature range -40 .. +80 °C
technology. Fluid temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Special features: mark1) Certificate No. E318391
1 or 2 PNP transistor switching Vibration resistance to ≤ 10 g
outputs, up to 1.2 A load per output DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Accuracy ≤ ± 1 % FS Shock resistance to ≤ 50 g
DIN EN 60068-2-29 (11 ms)
Optional switchable analogue output
(4 .. 20 mA / 0 .. 10 V) Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 67
Other data
4-digit digital display Supply voltage 9 .. 35 V DC without analogue output
Optimum alignment - can be 18 .. 35 V DC with analogue output
rotated in two planes (axes) for use acc. to UL spec. - limited energy - according to
9.3 UL 61010; Class 2;
Measured value can be displayed in UL 1310/1585; LPS UL 60950
bar, psi or MPa Current consumption max. 2.455 A total
User-friendly due to key max. 35 mA with inactive switching outputs
programming max. 55 mA with inactive switching outputs
and analogue output
Switching points and switch-back
hystereses can be adjusted Display 4-digit, LED, 7 segment, red,
height of digits 7 mm
E 18.060.3/11.13
independently
Weight ~ 120 g
Many useful additional functions
Note: Excess voltage, override protection and short circuit protection are provided.
Optional Desina®-compliant pin FS (Full Scale) = relative to the complete measurement range
configuration with diagnostic 1)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No 61010-1
function
37
Setting options: Model code:
All settings available on the EDS 3400 are
grouped in 2 easy-to-navigate menus. EDS 3 4 X X – X – XXXX – 000
In order to prevent unauthorised
adjustment of the device, a programming Mechanical connection
lock can be set. 4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
9 = Threaded port DIN 3852-G1/4
38
Dimensions: Pin connections:
M12x1, 4 pole
display
turns thru
270°
M12x1, 5 pole
1 2
Pin EDS
male electr. conn. M12x1
4 pole/5 pole 34X8-5
1 +UB
2 Analogue
3 0V
4 SP 1
5 SP 2
M12x1, 5 pole
4 3
5
1 2
DESINA®- Can be
compliant connected to
DESINA®
Pin EDS EDS
34X8-1 34X8-3
1 +UB +UB
2 Diagnostics Diagnostics
3 0V 0V
4 SP 1 SP 1
5 n.c. Analogue
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
E 18.060.3/11.13
39
3
40
E 18.060.3/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 3400
with Menu Navigation to VDMA
3
Description: Technical data:
The EDS 3400 is a compact electronic Input data
pressure switch with integrated Measuring ranges 40; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
digital display for relative pressure Overload pressures 80; 200; 500; 800; 1000 bar
measurement in the high-pressure Burst pressure 200; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000 bar
range. Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
The device has a stainless steel Threaded port DIN 3852-G1/4
measurement cell with thin-film strain Torque value 20 Nm
gauge. Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
The device can have one or two Sensor cell: Stainless steel
switching outputs, and there is the Seal: FPM
option of an additional switchable Output data
analogue output signal (4 .. 20 mA Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
or 0 .. 10 V). Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
A special design feature of the (display, analogue output)
Repeatability ≤ ± 0.25 % FS max.
EDS 3400 is that the display can be
Temperature drift ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. zero point
moved in two planes. The unit can ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. range
be installed in almost any mounting Analogue output (optional)
position and the display can be turned
Signal selectable:
to the optimum position without 4 .. 20 mA load resistance max. 500 W
the usual additional expense of a 0 .. 10 V load resistance min. 1 kW
mechanical adapter. The 4-digit display Switch outputs
can indicate the pressure in bar, psi or Type PNP transistor output
MPa. The user can select the individual Switching current max. 1.2 A
measurement unit. When changing to a Switching cycles > 100 million
different measurement unit, the Reaction time < 10 ms
EDS 3400 automatically converts all Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
the switching settings to the new unit of
Environmental conditions
measurement.
Compensated temperature range -10 .. +70 °C
The main applications of the Operating temperature range -25 .. +80 °C (-25 .. +60 °C acc. to UL spec.)
EDS 3400 are primarily in hydraulics Storage temperature range -40 .. +80 °C
and pneumatics, as well as in Fluid temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
refrigeration and air conditioning mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
technology. mark1) Certificate No. E318391
Special features: Vibration resistance to
DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
≤ 10 g
Menu navigation according to VDMA
Shock resistance to ≤ 50 g
1 or 2 PNP transistor switching DIN EN 60068-2-29 (11 ms)
outputs, up to 1.2 A load per output Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 67
Accuracy ≤ ± 1 % FS Other data
Optional analogue output selectable Supply voltage 9 .. 35 V DC without analogue output
(4 .. 20 mA / 0 .. 10 V) 18 .. 35 V DC with analogue output
for use acc. to UL spec. - limited energy - according to
4-digit digital display 9.3 UL 61010; Class 2;
Rotation in two planes (axes) UL 1310/1585; LPS UL 60950
for optimum alignment Current consumption max. 2.455 A total
Measured value can be displayed in max. 35 mA with inactive switching outputs
max. 55 mA with inactive switching outputs
bar, psi or MPa and analogue output
User-friendly due to key programming Display 4-digit, LED, 7 segment, red,
Switching points and switch-back height of digits 7 mm
hystereses can be adjusted
E 18.368.1/11.13
Weight ~ 120 g
independently
Note: Excess voltage, override protection and short circuit protection are provided.
Many useful additional functions FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
1)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No 61010-1
41
Setting options: Model code:
All terms and symbols used for setting the
EDS 3400 as well as the menu structure EDS 3 4 X 6 – X – XXXX – V00
comply with the specifications in the
VDMA Standard (VDMA 24574-1) for Mechanical connection
pressure switches. 4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
9 = Threaded port DIN 3852-G1/4
The EDS 3400 can easily be adjusted via Electrical connection
three buttons. 6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
Output
Setting ranges for the switch 1 = 1 switching output
outputs: 2 = 2 switching outputs
3 = 1 switching output and 1 analogue output
Measuring Lower Upper limit of Pressure ranges in bar
range limit of SP / FH 040;100; 250; 400; 600
RP / FL
Modification number
in bar in bar in bar
V00 = Menu navigation in accordance with VDMA (Standard Sheet 24574)
0 .. 40 0.4 40.0
0 .. 100 1.0 100.0
Notes:
0 .. 250 2.5 250.0
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
0 .. 400 4 400
3 technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
0 .. 600 6 600
Accessories:
Measuring Min. difference Incre- Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, mechanical adapters, splash
range betw. ment* guards, clamps for wall-mounting etc can be found in the Accessories brochure.
RP and SP
in bar & FL and FH in bar
0 .. 40 0.4 0.1
0 .. 100 1.0 0.2
0 .. 250 2.5 0.5
0 .. 400 4 1
0 .. 600 6 1 Dimensions:
* All ranges given in the table
are adjustable by the increments
shown.
SP = switch point
RP = switch-back point
FL = pressure window lower value display
turns thru
FH = pressure window upper value 270°
Additional functions:
Switching mode of the switching outputs
adjustable (switching point function or
window function)
housing
Switching direction of the switching turns thru
outputs adjustable (N/C or N/O function) 340°
M12x1, 4 pole
42
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 3400
with IO-Link Interface
3
Description: Technical data:
The EDS 3400 with IO-Link Input data
communication interface is a compact Measuring ranges 40; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
electronic pressure switch with Overload range 80; 200; 500; 800; 1000 bar
integrated digital display for relative Burst pressures 200; 500; 1000; 2000, 2000 bar
pressure measurement in the high- Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
pressure range. Threaded port DIN 3852-G1/4
The device is equipped with a switching Torque value 20 Nm
output and additional output that can be Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
configured as switching or analogue Sensor cell: Stainless steel
(4 .. 20 mA or 0 .. 10 V). Seal: FPM
Compared with the standard version, Output data
the IO-Link interface enables Output signals Output 1: PNP Transistor switching output
bidirectional communication between Output 2: can be configured as PNP transistor
the device and the control. switching output or analogue output
Parameterisation and cyclical Accuracy to DIN 16086 ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
transmission of process and service Max. setting (display, analogue output) ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
data is therefore possible. Repeatability ≤ ± 0.25 % FS max.
The pressure switch series EDS 3400 Temperature drift ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. zero point
≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. range
with communication interface IO-Link
Analogue output
according to specification V1.1 has
been specially designed for connecting Signal selectable: 4 .. 20 mA load resistance max. 500 Ω
0 .. 10 V load resistance min. 1 kΩ
sensors in automation systems.
Switch outputs
Typical fields of application are
machine tools, handling and assembly Type PNP transistor switching output
automation, intralogistics or the Switching current max. 250 mA per output
packaging industry. Switching cycles > 100 million
Reaction time < 10 ms
Long term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
Special features: Parameterisation Via IO-Link interface, with HYDAC
1 PNP transistor switching output programming device HPG 3000 or push
1 universal output, configurable buttons on the EDS 3400
as PNP transistor switching output or Environmental conditions
analogue output Compensated temperature range -10 .. +70 °C
Accuracy ≤ ± 1 % FS Operating temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
Storage temperature range -40 .. +80 °C
4-digit digital display
Fluid temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
Optimum alignment: can be rotated in - mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
two axes Vibration resistance according to ≤ 10 g
DIN EN 60068-2-6 (0 .. 500 Hz)
Shock resistance according to ≤ 50 g
DIN EN 60068-2-29 (11 ms)
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 67
Other data
Supply voltage 9 .. 35 V DC without analogue output
18 .. 35 V DC with analogue output
Current consumption ≤ 0.535 A with active switching outputs
≤ 35 mA with inactive switching outputs
≤ 55 mA with inactive switching output
and analogue output
E 18.368.1.0/11.13
43
Setting options: IO-Link-specific data:
All terms and symbols used for setting the
EDS 3400 as well as the menu structure Baud rate 38.4 kBaud *
comply with the specifications in the Cycle time 2.5 ms
VDMA Standard for pressure switches. Process data width 16 Bit
Frame type 2.2
Setting ranges for the switch Specification V1.1
outputs: *C
onnection with unshielded standard sensor line possible
up to a max. line length of 20 m.
Measuring Lower limit of Upper limit of Download the IO Device Description (IODD) from:
range RP / FL SP / FH http://www.hydac.com/de-en/service/downloads-software-on-request/
in bar in bar in bar
0 .. 40 0.4 40.0
0 .. 100 1.0 100.0 Model code:
0 .. 250 2.5 250.0
0 .. 400 4 400
EDS 3 4 X 6 – L – XXXX – 000
0 .. 600 6 600 Mechanical connection
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
Measuring Min. difference Incre-
9 = Threaded port DIN 3852-G1/4
range betw. ment* Electrical connection
3 RP and SP 6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
in bar & FL and FH in bar (connector not supplied)
0 .. 40 0.4 0.1 Output
0 .. 100 1.0 0.2 L = IO Link Interface
0 .. 250 2.5 0.5 Pressure ranges in bar
0 .. 400 4 1 0040; 0100; 0250; 0400; 0600
0 .. 600 6 1 Modification number
000 = Standard
* All ranges given in the table are
adjustable by the increments shown.
SP = switch point Notes:
RP = switch-back point On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
FL = pressure window lower value technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
FH = pressure window upper value Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, mechanical adapters, splash
Additional functions: guards, clamps for wall-mounting etc can be found in the Accessories brochure.
Switching mode of the switching outputs
adjustable (switching point function or
window function)
Switching direction of the switching
outputs adjustable (N/C or N/O function) Dimensions: Ø 42
25.5 40.4
M12x1 11
Switch-on and switch-off delay
adjustable from 0.00 .. 99.99 seconds
Analogue output signal selectable: display turns
4 .. 20 mA or 0 .. 10 V thru 270°
Pin connections:
64
75
housing turns
thru 340°
2 +0.1
M12x1, 4 pole
12
L+ hex. SW27
IO-Link G1/4 A DIN 3852-E
Ø 18.9 -0.2 16.1
1 C/Q
2 4 Ø 29.5
3
Elastomer profile gasket
DIN 3869
L- Standard IO Ø 53.5
I/Q
44
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 3300
3
Description: Technical data:
The EDS 3300 is a compact electronic Input data
pressure switch with integrated Measuring ranges -1 .. 1; 1; 2.5; 6; 10; 16 bar
digital display for relative pressure Overload pressures 3; 3; 8; 18; 30; 48 bar
measurement in the low-pressure Burst pressures 5; 5; 12; 30; 50; 80 bar
range. It has a ceramic measuring Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
cell with thick-film strain gauge. The G1/2 B DIN-EN 837
Threaded port DIN 3852-G1/4
instrument can have one or two
Torque value 20 Nm (G1/4)
switching outputs, and there is the 45 Nm (G1/2)
option of an additional switchable Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
analogue output signal (4 .. 20 mA or Sensor cell: Ceramic
0 .. 10 V). A special design feature of Seal: copper (G1/2) / FPM / EPDM
the EDS 3300 is that the display can (as per model code)
be moved in two planes (axes). The Output data
instrument can be installed in almost Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
any mounting position and the display (display, analogue output)
can be turned to the optimum position Repeatability ≤ ± 0.25 % FS max.
without the usual additional expense Temperature drift ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. zero point
of a mechanical adapter. The 4-digit ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. range
display can indicate the pressure in bar, Analogue output (optional)
psi or MPa. The user can select the Signal selectable:
particular unit of measurement. When 4 .. 20 mA load resistance max. 500 W
changing to a different measurement 0 .. 10 V load resistance min. 1 kW
unit, the instrument automatically Switch outputs
converts all the switching settings to the Type PNP transistor output
new unit of measurement. In addition, Switching current max. 1.2 A
the EDS 3300 is also available in a Switching cycles > 100 million
Reaction time < 10 ms
DESINA®-compliant version.
Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
The main applications of the EDS 3300 are
DESINA® diagnostic signal (Pin 2)
primarily in hydraulics and pneumatics,
Function OK: HIGH level / not OK: LOW level
as well as in refrigeration and air Level HIGH: approx. +UB / LOW: < +0.3 V
conditioning technology. Environmental conditions
Special features: Compensated temperature range -10 .. +70 °C
1 or 2 PNP transistor switching Operating temperature range -25 .. +80 °C (-25 .. +60 °C acc. to UL spec.)
outputs, up to 1.2 A load Storage temperature range -40 .. +80 °C
per output Fluid temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Accuracy ≤ ± 1 % FS
mark1) Certificate No. E318391
Optional switchable Vibration resistance to ≤ 10 g
analogue output (4 .. 20 mA / 0 .. 10 V) DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
4-digit digital display Shock resistance to ≤ 50 g
DIN EN 60068-2-29 (11 ms)
Optimum alignment - can be rotated Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 67
in two axes Other data
Measured value can be displayed in Supply voltage 9 .. 35 V DC without analogue output
bar, psi or MPa 18 .. 35 V DC with analogue output
User-friendly due to key for use acc. to UL spec. - limited energy - according to
9.3 UL 61010; Class 2;
programming UL 1310/1585; LPS UL 60950
Switching points and switch-back Current consumption max. 2.455 A total
hystereses can be adjusted max. 35 mA with inactive switching outputs
independently max. 55 mA with inactive switching outputs
E 18.068.2/11.13
46
Dimensions: Pin connections:
M12x1, 4 pole
display
turns thru
270°
1 2
Pin EDS
male electr. conn. M12x1
4 pole/5 pole 33X8-5
1 +UB
2 Analogue
3 0V
4 SP 1
5 SP 2
M12x1, 5 pole
4 3
5
1 2
DESINA®- Can be
compliant connected to
DESINA®
Pin EDS EDS
33X8-1 33X8-3
1 +UB +UB
2 Diagnostics Diagnostics
3 0V 0V
4 SP 1 SP 1
5 n.c. Analogue
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
E 18.068.2/11.13
47
3
48
E 18.068.2/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 3300
with Menu Navigation to VDMA
3
Description: Technical data:
The EDS 3300 is a compact electronic Input data
pressure switch with integrated Measuring ranges -1..1; 1; 2.5; 6; 10; 16 bar
digital display for relative pressure Overload pressures 3; 3; 8, 18, 30, 48 bar
measurement in the low-pressure Burst pressures 5; 5; 12; 30; 50; 80 bar
range. Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
It has a ceramic measuring cell with Threaded port DIN 3852-G1/4
thick-film strain gauge. The instrument Torque value 20 Nm
can have one or two switching outputs, Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
and there is the option of an additional Sensor cell: Ceramic
switchable analogue output signal Seal: FPM / EPDM
(4 .. 20 mA or 0 .. 10 V). (as per model code)
A special design feature of the Output data
EDS 3300 is that the display can be Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
rotated in two planes. The unit can Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
be installed in almost any mounting (display, analogue output)
position and the display can be turned Repeatability ≤ ± 0.25 % FS max.
to the optimum position without Temperature drift ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. zero point
the usual additional expense of a ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. range
mechanical adapter. The 4-digit display Analogue output (optional)
can indicate the pressure in bar, psi or Signal selectable:
MPa. The user can select the particular 4 .. 20 mA load resistance max. 500 W
measurement unit. When changing to a 0 .. 10 V load resistance min. 1 kW
different measurement unit, the Switch outputs
EDS 3300 automatically converts all Type PNP transistor output
the switching settings to the new unit of Switching current max. 1.2 A
measurement. Switching cycles > 100 million
The main applications of the Reaction time < 10 ms
EDS 3300 are primarily in hydraulics Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
and pneumatics, as well as in Environmental conditions
refrigeration and air conditioning Compensated temperature range -10 .. +70 °C
technology. Operating temperature range -25 .. +80 °C (-25 ... +60 °C acc. to UL spec.)
Storage temperature range -40 .. +80 °C
Special features: Fluid temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
Menu navigation according to VDMA
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
1 or 2 PNP transistor switching mark1) Certificate No. E318391
outputs, up to 1.2 A load
Vibration resistance to ≤ 10 g
per output DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Accuracy ≤ ± 1 % FS Shock resistance to ≤ 50 g
Optional analogue output selectable DIN EN 60068-2-29 (11 ms)
(4 .. 20 mA / 0 .. 10 V) Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 67
4-digit digital display Other data
Optimum alignment - can be Supply voltage 9 .. 35 V DC without analogue output
rotated in two planes (axes) 18 .. 35 V DC with analogue output
for use acc. to UL spec. - limited energy - according to
Measured value can be displayed in 9.3 UL 61010; Class 2;
bar, psi or MPa UL 1310/1585; LPS UL 60950
User-friendly due to Current consumption max. 2.455 A total
key programming max. 35 mA with inactive switching outputs
Switching points and switch-back max. 55 mA with inactive switching outputs
hystereses can be adjusted and analogue output
E 18.369.2/11.13
Additional functions:
Switching mode of the switching outputs
adjustable (switching point function or
window function)
housing
Switching direction of the switching turns thru
outputs adjustable (N/C or N/O function) 340°
50
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 3300
with IO-Link Interface
3
Description: Technical data:
The EDS 3300 with IO-Link Input data
communication interface is a compact Measuring ranges -1..1; 1; 2.5; 6; 10; 16 bar
electronic pressure switch with Overload range 3; 3; 8; 18; 30; 48 bar
integrated digital display for relative Burst pressures 5; 5; 12; 30; 50; 80 bar
pressure measurement in the low- Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
pressure range. Threaded port DIN 3852-G1/4
The device is equipped with a switching Torque value 20 Nm
output and additional output that can be Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
configured as switching or analogue Sensor cell: Ceramic
(4 .. 20 mA or 0 .. 10 V). Seal: FPM / EPDM (as per model code)
Compared with the standard version, Output data
the IO-Link interface enables Output signals Output 1: PNP transistor switching output
bidirectional communication between Output 2: can be configured as PNP transistor
the device and the control. switching output or analogue output
Parameterisation and cyclical Accuracy to DIN 16086 ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
transmission of process and service Max. setting (display, analogue output) ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
data is therefore possible. Repeatability ≤ ± 0.25 % FS max.
The pressure switch series EDS 3300 Temperature drift ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. zero point
≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. range
with communication interface IO-Link
Analogue output
according to specification V1.1 has
been specially designed for connecting Signal selectable: 4 .. 20 mA load resistance max. 500 Ω
0 .. 10 V load resistance min. 1 kΩ
sensors in automation systems.
Switch outputs
Typical fields of application are
machine tools, handling and assembly Type PNP transistor switching output
automation, intralogistics or the Switching current max. 250 mA per output
packaging industry. Switching cycles > 100 million
Reaction time < 10 ms
Long term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
Special features: Parameterisation Via IO-Link interface, with HYDAC
IO Link Interface programming device HPG 3000 or push
1 PNP transistor switching output buttons on the EDS 3300
Environmental conditions
Additional signal output,
Compensated temperature range -10 .. +70 °C
can be configured as PNP transistor
switching output or analogue output Operating temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
Storage temperature range -40 .. +80 °C
Accuracy ≤ ± 1 % FS
Fluid temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
4-digit digital display - mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Display can be rotated in two axes for Vibration resistance according to ≤ 10 g
optimal alignment DIN EN 60068-2-6 (0 .. 500 Hz)
Shock resistance according to ≤ 50 g
DIN EN 60068-2-29 (11 ms)
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 67
Other data
Supply voltage 9 .. 35 V DC without analogue output
18 .. 35 V DC with analogue output
Current consumption ≤ 0.535 A with active switching outputs
≤ 35 mA with inactive switching outputs
≤ 55 mA with inactive switching output
and analogue output
E 18.369.1.0/11.13
51
Setting options: IO-Link-specific data:
All terms and symbols used for setting the Baud rate 38.4 kBaud *
EDS 3300 as well as the menu structure Cycle time 2.5 ms
comply with the specifications in the Process data width 16 Bit
VDMA Standard for pressure switches. Frame type 2.2
Specification V1.1
Setting ranges for the switch *C
onnection with unshielded standard sensor line possible
outputs: up to a max. line length of 20 m.
Download the IO Device Description (IODD) from:
Measuring Lower limit of Upper limit of http://www.hydac.com/de-en/service/downloads-software-on-request/
range RP / FL SP / FH
in bar in bar in bar Model code:
- 1 .. 1 -0.98 1.00
0 .. 1 0.010 1.000 EDS 3 3 X 6 – L – XXXX – 000 – X 1
0 .. 2.5 0.025 2.500
Mechanical connection
0 .. 6 0.06 6.00
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
0 .. 10 0.10 10.00 9 = Threaded port DIN 3852-G1/4
0 .. 16 0.20 16.00
Electrical connection
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
Measuring Min. difference Incre- (connector not supplied)
3 range betw. ment* Output
RP and SP
in bar & FL and FH in bar
L = IO Link Interface
- 1 .. 1 0.02 0.01 Pressure ranges in bar
0 .. 1 0.010 0.002 0001 (-1 .. 1 bar); 01.0; 02.5; 06.0; 0010; 0016
0 .. 2.5 0.025 0.005 Modification number
0 .. 6 0.06 0.01 000 = Standard
0 .. 10 0.10 0.02 Seal material (in contact with fluid)
0 .. 16 0.20 0.05 F = FPM seal (e.g. for hydraulic oils)
E = EPDM seal (e.g. for water, refrigerants)
* All ranges given in the table are
adjustable by the increments shown. Material of connection (in contact with fluid)
SP = switch point 1 = Stainless steel
RP = switch-back point Notes:
FL = pressure window lower value On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
FH = pressure window upper value technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Additional functions: Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, mechanical adapters, splash
Switching mode of the switching outputs guards, clamps for wall-mounting etc can be found in the Accessories brochure.
adjustable (switching point function or
window function)
Switching direction of the switching
outputs adjustable (N/C or N/O function) Dimensions: Ø 42
25.5 40.4
M12x1 11
Switch-on and switch-off delay
adjustable from 0.00 .. 99.99 seconds
Analogue output signal selectable to display turns
4 .. 20 mA or 0 .. 10 V thru 270°
13
13
Ø 20
MPa.
91.5
Pin connections:
75
64
housing turns
thru 340°
2 +0.1
M12x1, 4 pole
12
L+ hex. SW27
IO-Link
G1/4 A DIN 3852-E
1 C/Q Ø 18.9 -0.2 16.1
2 4 Ø 29.5
3
Elastomer profile gasket
L- Standard IO DIN 3869
Ø 53.5
I/Q
analogue output
3 L- Gnd Note:
4 C/Q IO-Link communication / The information in this brochure relates to
E 18.369.1.0/11.13
52
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 3100
3
Description: Technical data:
The EDS 3100 is a compact electronic Input data
pressure switch with integrated Measuring ranges 1; 2.5 bar
digital display for absolute pressure Overload pressures 3; 8 bar
measurement in the low-pressure Burst pressures 5; 12 bar
range. It has a ceramic measuring Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
cell with thick-film strain gauge. The G1/2 B DIN-EN 837
instrument can have one or two Threaded port DIN 3852-G1/4
switching outputs, and there is the Torque value 20 Nm (G1/4)
45 Nm (G1/2)
option of an additional switchable
Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
analogue output signal (4 .. 20 mA or Sensor cell: Ceramic
0 .. 10 V). Seal: copper (G1/2) / FPM / EPDM
A special design feature of the (as per model code)
EDS 3100 is that the display can be Output data
rotated in two planes. The instrument Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
can be installed in almost any mounting Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
position and the display can be turned (display, analogue output)
Repeatability ≤ ± 0.25 % FS max.
to the optimum position without
Temperature drift ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. zero point
the usual additional expense of a ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. range
mechanical adapter. The 4-digit display Analogue output (optional)
can indicate the pressure in bar, psi or Signal selectable:
MPa. The user can select the particular 4 .. 20 mA load resistance max. 500 W
unit of measurement. When changing 0 .. 10 V load resistance min. 1 kW
to a different measurement unit, the Switch outputs
instrument automatically converts all Type PNP transistor output
the switching settings to the new unit of Switching current max. 1.2 A
measurement. In addition, the EDS 3100 is Switching cycles > 100 million
also available in a DESINA® -compliant Reaction time < 10 ms
version. Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
The main applications of the DESINA® diagnostic signal (Pin 2)
EDS 3100 are primarily in hydraulics Function OK: HIGH level / not OK: LOW level
and pneumatics, as well as in Level HIGH: approx. +UB / LOW: < +0.3 V
refrigeration and air conditioning Environmental conditions
technology. Compensated temperature range -10 .. +70 °C
Operating temperature range -25 .. +80 °C (-25 .. +60 °C acc. to UL spec.)
Special features: Storage temperature range -40 .. +80 °C
1 or 2 PNP transistor switching Fluid temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
outputs, up to 1.2 A load per output mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Accuracy ≤ ± 1 % FS mark1) Certificate No. E318391
Optional switchable Vibration resistance to ≤ 10 g
analogue output (4 .. 20 mA / 0 .. 10 V) DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Shock resistance to ≤ 50 g
4-digit digital display DIN EN 60068-2-29 (11 ms)
Optimum alignment - can be rotated Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 67
in two axes Other data
Measured value can be displayed in Supply voltage 9 .. 35 V DC without analogue output
bar, psi or MPa 18 .. 35 V DC with analogue output
for use acc. to UL spec. - limited energy - according to
User-friendly due to key programming 9.3 UL 61010; Class 2;
Switching points and switch- UL 1310/1585; LPS UL 60950
back hystereses can be adjusted Current consumption max. 2.455 A total
independently max. 35 mA with inactive switching outputs
max. 55 mA with inactive switching outputs
E 18.069.1/11.13
Note:
For instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or
the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
E 18.069.1/11.13
54
Dimensions: Pin connections:
M12x1, 4 pole
display
turns thru
270°
M12x1, 5 pole
G1/2 B
DIN EN 837
flat seal ring Cu
4 3
Elastomer profile gasket 5
DIN 3869
1 2
Pin EDS
male electr. conn. M12x1
4 pole/5 pole 31X8-5
1 +UB
2 Analogue
3 0V
4 SP 1
5 SP 2
M12x1, 5 pole
4 3
5
1 2
DESINA®- Can be
compliant connected to
DESINA®
Pin EDS EDS
31X8-1 31X8-3
1 +UB +UB
2 Diagnostics Diagnostics
3 0V 0V
4 SP 1 SP 1
5 n.c. Analogue
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
E 18.069.1/11.13
55
3
56
E 18.069.1/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 3100
with Menu Navigation to VDMA
3
Description: Technical data:
The EDS 3100 is a compact electronic Input data
pressure switch with integrated Measuring ranges 1; 2.5 bar
digital display for absolute pressure Overload pressures 3; 8 bar
measurement in the low-pressure Burst pressures 5; 12 bar
range. Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
It has a ceramic measuring cell with Threaded port DIN 3852-G1/4
thick-film strain gauge. The instrument Torque value 20 Nm
can have one or two switching outputs, Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
and there is the option of an additional Sensor cell: Ceramic
switchable analogue output signal Seal: FPM / EPDM
(4 .. 20 mA or 0 .. 10 V). (as per model code)
A special design feature of the Output data
EDS 3100 is that the display can be Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
rotated in two planes. The unit can Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
be installed in almost any mounting (display, analogue output)
position and the display can be turned Repeatability ≤ ± 0.25 % FS max.
to the optimum position without Temperature drift ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. zero point
the usual additional expense of a ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. range
mechanical adapter. The 4-digit display Analogue output (optional)
can indicate the pressure in bar, psi or Signal selectable:
MPa. The user can select the particular 4 .. 20 mA load resistance max. 500 W
measurement unit. When changing to a 0 .. 10 V load resistance min. 1 kW
different measurement unit, the Switch outputs
EDS 3100 automatically converts all Type PNP transistor output
the switching settings to the new unit of Switching current max. 1.2 A
measurement. Switching cycles > 100 million
The main applications of the Reaction time < 10 ms
EDS 3100 are primarily in hydraulics Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
and pneumatics, as well as in Environmental conditions
refrigeration and air conditioning Compensated temperature range -10 .. +70 °C
technology. Operating temperature range -25 .. +80 °C (-25 .. +60 °C acc. to UL spec.)
Storage temperature range -40 .. +80 °C
Special features: Fluid temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
Menu navigation according to VDMA
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
1 or 2 PNP transistor switching mark1) Certificate No. E318391
outputs, up to 1.2 A load per output
Vibration resistance to ≤ 10 g
Accuracy ≤ ± 1 % FS DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Optional analogue output selectable Shock resistance to ≤ 50 g
(4 .. 20 mA / 0 .. 10 V) DIN EN 60068-2-29 (11 ms)
4-digit digital display Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 67
Other data
Optimum alignment - can be
rotated in two planes (axes) Supply voltage 9 .. 35 V DC without analogue output
18 .. 35 V DC with analogue output
Measured value can be displayed in for use acc. to UL spec. - limited energy - according to
bar, psi or MPa 9.3 UL 61010; Class 2;
User-friendly due to UL 1310/1585; LPS UL 60950
key programming Current consumption max. 2.455 A total
Switching points and switch-back max. 35 mA with inactive switching outputs
hystereses can be adjusted max. 55 mA with inactive switching outputs
independently and analogue output
E 18.370.1/11.13
Additional functions:
Switching mode of the switching outputs
adjustable (switching point function or
window function)
display
Switching direction of the switching turns thru
outputs adjustable (N/C or N/O function) 270°
Pin connections:
hex-SW27
M12x1, 4 pole
58
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 3100
with IO-Link Interface
3
Description: Technical data:
The EDS 3100 with IO-Link Input data
communication interface is a compact Measuring ranges 1; 2.5 bar
electronic pressure switch with Overload pressures 3; 8 bar
integrated digital display for absolute Burst pressures 5; 12 bar
pressure measurement in the low- Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
pressure range. Threaded port DIN 3852-G1/4
The instrument is equipped with a Torque value 20 Nm
switching output and additional output Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
that can be configured as switching or Sensor cell: Ceramic
analogue (4 .. 20 mA or 0 .. 10 V). Seal: FPM / EPDM (as per model code)
Compared with the standard version, Output data
the IO-Link interface enables Output signals Output 1: PNP transistor switching output
bidirectional communication between Output 2: can be configured as PNP transistor
the device and the control. switching output or analogue output
Parameterisation and cyclical Accuracy to DIN 16086 ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
transmission of process and service Max. setting (display, analogue output) ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
data is therefore possible. Repeatability ≤ ± 0.25 % FS max.
The pressure switch series EDS 3100 Temperature drift ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. zero point
≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max. range
with communication interface IO-Link
Analogue output
according to specification V1.1 has
been specially designed for connecting Signal selectable: 4 .. 20 mA load resistance max. 500 Ω
0 .. 10 V load resistance min. 1 kΩ
sensors in automation systems.
Switch outputs
Typical fields of application are
machine tools, handling and assembly Type PNP transistor switching output
automation, intralogistics or the Switching current max. 250 mA per output
packaging industry. Switching cycles > 100 million
Reaction time < 10 ms
Long term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
Special features: Parameterisation Via IO-Link interface, with HYDAC
IO Link Interface programming device HPG 3000 or push
1 PNP transistor switching output buttons on the EDS 3100
Environmental conditions
Additional signal output,
Compensated temperature range -10 .. +70 °C
can be configured as PNP transistor
switching output or analogue output Operating temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
Storage temperature range -40 .. +80 °C
Accuracy ≤ ± 1 % FS
Fluid temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
4-digit digital display - mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Can be rotated in two axes for optimal Vibration resistance according to ≤ 10 g
alignment DIN EN 60068-2-6 (0 .. 500 Hz)
Shock resistance according to ≤ 50 g
DIN EN 60068-2-29 (11 ms)
Protection class to IEC 60259 IP 67
Other data
Supply voltage 9 .. 35 V DC without analogue output
18 .. 35 V DC with analogue output
Current consumption ≤ 0.535 A with active switching outputs
≤ 35 mA with inactive switching outputs
≤ 55 mA with inactive switching output
and analogue output
E 18.370.1.0/11.13
59
Setting options: IO-Link-specific data:
All terms and symbols used for setting the Baud rate 38.4 kBaud *
EDS 3100 as well as the menu structure Cycle time 2.5 ms
comply with the specifications in the Process data width 16 Bit
VDMA Standard for pressure switches. Frame type 2.2
Specification V1.1
Setting ranges for the switch *C
onnection with unshielded standard sensor line possible
outputs: up to a max. line length of 20 m.
Download the IO Device Description (IODD) from:
Measuring Lower limit of Upper limit of http://www.hydac.com/de-en/service/downloads-software-on-request/
range RP / FL SP / FH
in bar in bar in bar Model code:
0 .. 1 0.010 1.000
0 .. 2.5 0.025 2.500 EDS 3 1 X 6 – L – XXXX – 000 – X 1
Mechanical connection
Measuring Min. difference Incre- 4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
range betw. ment* 9 = Threaded port DIN 3852-G1/4
RP and SP
in bar & FL and FH in bar Electrical connection
0 .. 1 0.010 0.002
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
(connector not supplied)
0 .. 2.5 0.025 0.005
3 Output
* All ranges given in the table are L = IO Link Interface
adjustable by the increments shown. Pressure ranges in bar
SP = switch point
01.0; 02.5
RP = switch-back point
FL = pressure window lower value Modification number
FH = pressure window upper value 000 = Standard
Seal material (in contact with fluid)
Additional functions: F = FPM seal (e.g. for hydraulic oils)
Switching mode of the switching outputs E = EPDM seal (e.g. for water, refrigerants)
adjustable (switching point function or Material of connection (in contact with fluid)
window function) 1 = Stainless steel
Switching direction of the switching
Notes:
outputs adjustable (N/C or N/O function)
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
Switch-on and switch-off delay technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
adjustable from 0.00 .. 99.99 seconds
Accessories:
Analogue output signal selectable: Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, mechanical adapters, splash
4 .. 20 mA or 0 .. 10 V guards, clamps for wall-mounting etc can be found in the Accessories brochure.
Pressure can be displayed in bar, psi,
MPa.
13
L+
G1/4 DIN 3852
IO-Link
16
Ø 20
91.5
1 C/Q
2 4
3
64
75
housing turns
thru 340°
L- Standard IO
2 +0.1
I/Q
12
hex. SW27
G1/4 A DIN 3852-E
Pin Signal Description Ø 18.9 -0.2 16.1
1 L+ Supply voltage Ø 29.5
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
E 18.370.1.0/11.13
60
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 300
3
Description: Technical data:
The EDS 300 is a compact, electronic Input data
pressure switch with integral digital Measuring ranges 16; 40; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
display. Overload pressures 32; 80; 200; 500; 800; 1000 bar
Four different output models are
Burst pressures 200; 200; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000 bar
available: with one switching point, with
two switching points and both models Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
can also have an additional analogue Torque value 20 Nm
output signal 4 .. 20 mA. Parts in contact with medium Mech. conn.: Stainless steel
Seal: FPM
The switching points and the associated
Output data
hystereses can be adjusted using the
keypad. For optimum adaptation to a Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
particular application, the instrument Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
(display, analogue output)
has many additional adjustment
parameters, e.g. switching delay times, Repeatability ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
N/O / N/C function of the outputs. Temperature drift ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max. zero point
≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max. range
The main applications of the
Analogue output (optional)
EDS 300 are to indicate pressures and
Signal 4 .. 20 mA load resistance ≤ 400 W
limits in hydraulics and pneumatics
and anywhere where high switching Switch outputs
frequency or constant switching Type PNP transistor output
accuracy would overburden a Switching current max. 1.2 A per switch output
mechanical pressure switch. The unit is Switching cycles > 100 million
ideal for building accumulator charging Reaction time approx. 10 ms
circuits or pump and compressor Environmental conditions
controls. Compensation temperature range -10 .. +70 °C
Operating temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
Storage temperature range -40 .. +80 °C
Special features: Fluid temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
Integrated pressure sensor
with thin-film strain gauge on mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
stainless steel membrane Vibration resistance to ≤ 10 g
Compact, robust construction DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Shock resistance to ≤ 50 g
Accuracy ≤ ± 1 % FS DIN EN 60068-2-29 (11 ms)
3-digit digital display Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65
Easy to operate thanks to Other data
key programming Supply voltage 20 .. 32 V DC
Switching points and switch-back Current consumption approx. 100 mA (inactive switch output)
hystereses can be adjusted
independently Display 3-digit, LED, 7 segment, red,
height of digits 9.2 mm
Window function
Weight ~ 300 g
Many useful additional functions
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and short circuit
protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
E 18.056.6/11.13
61
Setting options: Model code:
All settings available on the EDS 300 are
grouped in 2 easy-to-navigate menus. EDS 3 4 X – X – XXX – 000
In order to prevent unauthorised
adjustment of the device, a programming Mechanical connection
lock can be set. 4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
62
Dimensions: Pin connections:
profile
gasket
hex-SW27
M12x1, 4 pole
M12x1, 5 pole
4 3
5
1 2
applications described.
For applications or operating conditions Hauptstraße 27, D-66128 Saarbrücken
Telephone +49 (0)6897 509-01 3 0V
not described, please contact the relevant Fax +49 (0)6897 509-1726
technical department. 4 SP 1
E-mail: [email protected]
Subject to technical modifications. Internet: www.hydac.com 5 SP 2
63
3
64
E 18.056.6/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 300
with Approvals for Shipping
3
Description: Technical data:
The EDS 300 is a compact, electronic Input data
pressure switch with digital display. The Measuring ranges -1..5; 6; 16; 40; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
pressure measurement is based on a
strain gauge sensor cell in stainless Overload pressures 15; 15; 32; 80; 200; 500; 800; 1000 bar
steel. All parts in contact with the Burst pressures 100; 100; 200; 200; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000 bar
medium are in stainless steel, and are Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
welded together. Since no seals are Torque value 20 Nm
required in the sensor interior, leakage Parts in contact with medium Mech. conn.: Stainless steel
is eliminated. Seal: FPM
Two relay switch outputs with N/O Output data
function and an additional analogue
Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
output signal (4 .. 20 mA) enable the
Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
pressure switch to be incorporated into
(display, analogue output)
modern controls.
The switch points and the Repeatability ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
corresponding hystereses can easily be Temperature drift ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max. zero point
adjusted via the keypad. ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max. range
For optimum adaptation to a particular Analogue output
application, the instrument has many Signal 4 .. 20 mA load resistance ≤ 400 W
additional setting parameters, e.g. Switch outputs
switching direction of the relays or Type relay contacts (N/O)
switching delay times.
Switching voltage max. 60 V AC / DC
Areas of application are pressure or limit Switching current max. 1 A per switch output
monitoring on marine transmissions,
Switching capacity max. 30 W / 30 VA
diesel engines, pumps and general
(for inductive load, use varistors)
hydraulic and pneumatic systems.
Switching cycles 20 million at minimum load
0.5 million at maximum load
Reaction time approx. 10 ms
Environmental conditions
Approvals: Compensated temperature range -10 .. +70 °C
American Bureau Operating temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
of Shipping Storage temperature range -40 .. +80 °C
Fluid temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Lloyds Register
Vibration resistance to 5 .. 25 Hz: 3.2 mm
of Shipping DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz 25 .. 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock resistance to ≤ 50 g
DIN EN 60068-2-29 (1 ms)
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65
Det Norske Veritas
Other data
Supply voltage 20 .. 32 V DC
Current consumption approx. 100 mA (inactive switch output)
Display 4-digit, LED, 7 segment, red,
Germanischer Lloyd
height of digits 9.2 mm
Weight ~ 300 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and short circuit
protection are provided.
Bureau Veritas FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
E 18.058.5/11.13
Pin connections:
DIN 43651
hex. SW27
elastomer
profile gasket
DIN 3869
Pin EDS 347-4
1 +UB
2 Centre relay 1 and 2
3 Relay contact 1 (SP 1)
4 0V
5 Analogue
6 Relay contact 2 (SP 2)
^ Housing
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
E 18.058.5/11.13
66
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 8000
3
Description: Technical data:
EDS 8000 is an electronic pressure Input data
switch in compact design which is Measurement range 25; 40; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
simple to adjust.
Models with one or two transistor switch Overload pressures 80; 80; 200; 500; 800; 1000 bar
outputs (PNP or NPN) are available. Burst pressures 200; 200; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000 bar
The switch points are set using the Mechanical connection G¼ A DIN 3852; Form E
two keys and a four-digit display. Torque value 20 Nm
During operation the switch position Parts in contact with medium Mech. conn.: Stainless steel
is indicated by either a red or a green Sensor cell: Thin-film strain gauge
backlight in the display. Seal: FPM
For optimum adaptation to a particular Output data
application, the instrument has many Accuracy to DIN 16086 ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
additional adjustment parameters, Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
e.g. switching delay times, N/O / N/C (display)
function of the outputs. Repeatability ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
EDS 8000 is available in various Temperature drift (environment) ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max. zero point
pressure ranges between 0 .. 25 bar ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max. range
and 0 .. 600 bar. Long-term stability ≤ ± 0.25 % FS / year max.
The main applications of the EDS 8000 Switch outputs
are to indicate pressures and limits Type 1 or 2 transistor switching outputs
in hydraulics and pneumatics, or any PNP or NPN
application where high switching Switching current max. 250 mA per output
frequency or consistent switching Switching cycles > 100 million
accuracy would overburden a Reaction time < 10 ms
mechanical pressure switch.
Environmental conditions
Compensated temperature range -25 .. + 85 °C
Special features: Ambient temperature range1) -40 .. +100 °C / -25 °C +100 °C
Menu navigation according to VDMA Storage temperature range -40 .. + 85 °C
Fluid temperature range1) -40 .. +125 °C / -25 .. +125 °C
1 or 2 PNP transistor
Nominal temperature range of display -15 .. 70 °C
switching outputs
(read-out)
Robust stainless steel measurement mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
cell -mark2) Certificate No. E318391
Accuracy class ≤ ± 1 % FS Vibration resistance to approx. 10 g
4-digit display DIN EN 60068-2-6 (0 .. 500 Hz)
Multi-colour switch display Shock resistance to approx. 50 g
DIN EN 60068-2-29 (11 ms)
Protection class IP 67 Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 67 (when an IP 67 connector is used)
Simple operation with key Other data
programming Supply voltage 9.6 .. 32 V DC
Many useful additional functions for use acc. to UL spec. - limited energy - according to
9.3 UL 61010; Class 2;
UL 1310/1585; LPS UL 60950
Current consumption max. 0.535 A total
max. 35 mA (with inactive switch output)
Display 4-digit, LED, 7 segment,
height of digits 4.5 mm
Life expectancy > 10 million cycles (0 .. 100 %)
Weight ~ 70 g
E 18.365.2/11.13
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override
and short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to the complete measurement range
1)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
2)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No 61010-1
67
Setting options: Model code:
All the terms and symbols used for setting
the EDS 8000 as well as menu structure EDS 8 4 4 6 - X - XXXX – X00
comply with the specifications of the
German Engineering Federation Standard Mechanical connection
(VDMA 24574-1) for pressure switches. 4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
The EDS 8000 is easy and convenient to set Electrical connection
up using the two buttons. 6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
(connector not supplied)
Setting ranges for the switch
Output
outputs: 1 = 1 switching output
Meas. Lower Upper 2 = 2 switching outputs
range limit of limit of
RP / FL SP / FH
Pressure ranges in bar
in bar in bar in bar 0025; 0040; 0100; 0250; 0400; 0600
Modification number
0 .. 25 0.25 25.00
000 = Standard
0 .. 40 0.4 40.0 N00 = Version with NPN switching outputs
0 .. 100 1.0 100.0
0 .. 250 2.5 250.0 Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label
3 0 .. 400 4 400 or the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
0 .. 600 6 600
Accessories:
Meas. Min. difference Incre- Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, mechanical adapters, etc, can
range betw. RP & SP ment* be found in the Accessories brochure.
in bar and FL & FH in bar
0 .. 25 0.25 0.05
0 .. 40 0.4 0.1
0 .. 100 1.0 0.2
0 .. 250 2.5 0.5
0 .. 400 4 1
0 .. 600 6 1
* All ranges given in the table are Dimensions:
adjustable by the increments shown.
SP = Switching point
RP = Switch-back point
FL = Pressure window lower value
FH = Pressure window upper value
male electr. conn. M12x1,
Additional functions: 4 pole
Switching mode of the switching outputs
adjustable (switching point function or
window function)
Switching direction of the switching
outputs adjustable (N/C or N/O
function)
Switch-on and switch-off delay
adjustable from 0.00 .. 99.99 seconds
Display filter for smoothing the display
value during pressure pulsations
Pressure can be displayed in orifice
bar, psi, MPa
Pin connections:
M12x1, 4 pole
Note:
Pin EDS 8446-1 EDS 8446-2 The information in this brochure relates to
1 +UB +UB the operating conditions and
E 18.365.2/11.13
68
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 601
3
Description: Technical data:
The EDS 601 is an electronic two- Input data
way pressure switch with display and Measuring ranges 16; 40; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
analogue output. Overload pressures 24; 60; 200; 500; 800; 1000 bar
Its digitally adjustable switching points Burst pressures 200; 200; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000 bar
and switching hystereses, make it Mechanical connection Threaded port G1/4 DIN 3852
ideally suited to applications which Torque value 20 Nm
require frequent change-overs or Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
accurate switch point setting.
Output data
The variety of setting parameters
Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
ensures versatility for use in all control Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
and monitoring tasks in hydraulics, (display, analogue output)
pneumatics, process control and Repeatability ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
general test and control technology. Temperature drift ≤ ± 0.05 % FS / °C max. zero point
≤ ± 0.05 % FS / °C max. range
Special features: Analogue output (optional)
Signal selectable:
Two-channel pressure switch with 4 .. 20 mA ohmic resistance ≤ 400 W
change-over contacts 0 .. 10 V ohmic resistance ≥ 2 kW
Accuracy ≤ ± 1 % FS Switch outputs
4-digit LED display Type 2 relay outputs with change-over contacts
Signal output 4 .. 20 mA or Switching voltage max. 250 V
0 .. 10 V selectable Switching current max. 2 A per switch output
Can be installed as a pressure gauge Switching capacity max. 50 W / 400 VA
or as a front panel mounted unit Switching cycles 10 million without load
1 million with load
Digitally adjustable parameters
Reaction time approx. 10 ms including electronics
Optional permanent display of the Environmental conditions
switching point or of the pressure Compensated temperature range -10 .. +70 °C
peak value Operating temperature range -25 .. +70 °C
Can be set to display values in Storage temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
any unit of measurement e.g.: kN, kg, Fluid temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
psi, ...
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Vibration resistance to ≤ 25 g
DIN EN 60068-2-6 (0 .. 500 Hz)
Shock resistance to ≤ 100 g
DIN EN 60068-2-29 (1 ms)
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65
Other data
Supply voltage 20 .. 32 V DC
Current consumption approx. 120 mA
Switch-on current approx. 1.5 A (100 ms)
Display 4-digit, LED, 7 segment, red,
height of digits 13 mm
Connection supply voltage / EN175301-803 (DIN 43650) / ISO 4400
analogue output (3 pole + PE)
Connection relay outputs DIN 43651
(6 pole + PE)
E 18.052.6/11.13
69
Setting options: Pin connections: Model code:
The EDS 601 combines a multitude of
functions with easy operation so that EN175301-803 (DIN 43650) EDS 6 0 1 – XXX – 000
frequently-used parameters can be (voltage supply / analogue output)
changed quickly. Pressure ranges in bar
016; 040; 100; 250; 400; 600
Switch point settings:
Switching point relay 1 and 2 Modification number
(1 % .. 100 % FS) 000 = Standard
Switching hysteresis 1 and 2
(0.5 % .. 99 % FS) Note:
Basic settings: Pin Special models on request.
Switching direction relay 1 and 2 On instruments with a different
1 +UB
(pull-in/release) modification number, please read the
2 0V label or the technical amendment details
Switching delay relay 1 and 2 supplied with the instrument.
(0.00 .. 90 seconds) 3 Analogue
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
E 18.052.6/11.13
70
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 1700
3
Description: Technical data:
With its integrated pressure Input data
measurement cell, 4-digit display and Measuring ranges 16; 40; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
4 switching outputs, the EDS 1700
offers the user all the advantages of a Overload pressures 32; 80; 200; 500; 800; 1000 bar
modern electronic pressure switch. Burst pressures 200; 200; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000 bar
4 switching points and switch-back Mechanical connection Threaded port G1/4 DIN 3852
points can be adjusted very simply and Torque value 20 Nm
independently of one another using the Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
keypad. Output data
For optimum integration in monitoring
Accuracy to DIN 16086, EDS 1700-P: ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
systems (e.g. with PLC), an analogue
Max. setting EDS 1700-N: ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
output (4 .. 20 mA or 0 .. 10V) is also
(display, analogue output)
available.
The main areas of application of the Repeatability EDS 1700-P: ≤ ± 0.25 % FS max.
EDS 1700 are in hydraulics and EDS 1700-N: ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
pneumatics. The instrument is ideal for Temperature drift EDS 1700-P ≤ ± 0.02 % FS / °C max. zero point & range
use where frequent switching cycles Temperature drift EDS 1700-N ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max. zero point & range
(several million), stable switching Analogue output
point accuracy or simple and precise Signal (selectable) 4 .. 20 mA ohmic resistance ≤ 400W
adjustability are required. 0 .. 10 V ohmic resistance ≥ 2 kW
Switch outputs
Type 4 relays with change-over contacts
Special features: (2 groups, common supply of each group
Integrated pressure sensor with connected)
strain gauge on stainless steel Switching voltage 0.1 .. 250 V AC / DC
membrane Switching current 0.009 .. 2 A per switch output
Accuracy 0.5 % or 1 % FS Switching capacity max. 50 W / 400 VA
4-digit digital display (for inductive load, use varistors)
Switching cycles 20 million at minimum load
Simple operation via key 1 million at maximum load
programming
Reaction time approx. 20 ms
4 limit relays, switching points and Environmental conditions
switch back points can be adjusted Compensated temperature range -10 .. +70 °C
independently
Operating temperature range -25 .. +60 °C
Analogue output signal selectable Storage temperature range -40 .. +80 °C
Many useful additional functions Fluid temperature range -25 .. +80 °C
Optional mounting position mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
(pressure connection on the top/ Vibration resistance to ≤5g
bottom, keypad and display can be DIN EN 60068-2-6 (0 .. 500 Hz)
turned through 180°) Shock resistance to ≤ 10 g
Can be set to display values in DIN EN 60068-2-29 (1 ms)
any unit of measurement e.g.: kN, kg, Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65
psi, ... Other data
Supply voltage 22 .. 32 V DC
Current consumption approx. 200 mA
Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤ 10 %
Display 4-digit, LED, 7 segment, red,
height of digits 13 mm
Electrical connection 14-pole, terminal block
Housing material aluminium, anodised
E 18.055.5/11.13
Weight ~ 800 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and short circuit
protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
71
Setting options: Model code:
The core of the unit is a microprocessor
which provides many useful extra functions EDS 1 7 9 X – X – XXX – 000
in addition to normal pressure switch
operation. It is possible, for example, to Mechanical connection
activate switching delay times to prevent 9 = Threaded port G1/4 DIN 3852
fast pressure peaks from triggering an
Display
unwanted switching cycle. All settings are
1 = 4-digit bar
made using the keypad.
2 = 4-digit psi
Setting ranges of the Accuracy
switching points: P = 0.5 %
Switching point relay 1 to 4: N = 1 %
1.5 % .. 100 % FS Pressure ranges in bar
Switch-back relay 1 to 4: 016; 040; 100; 250; 400; 600
1 % .. 99 % FS
Modification number
or alternatively
000 = Standard
switch-back hysteresis 1 to 4:
1 % .. 99 % FS
Note: FS (Full Scale) = Note:
3
relative to the full measurement range
Special models on request.
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
Additional setting options: technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Switching direction of the relays 1 to 4
(N/C or N/O)
Switch-on delay relays 1 to 4 in the Accessories:
range 0.00 .. 90 seconds Appropriate accessories, such as mechanical adapters etc. can be found in the
Switch-off delay relays 1 to 4 in the Accessories brochure.
range 0.00 .. 90 seconds
Switch-back mode (either switch-back
point or switch-back hysteresis)
Display of the actual pressure, a
switching point or of the peak value
Display filter (slow / medium / fast)
Display range scale individually
adaptable (bar, psi, user-selectable)
Measurement unit (bar, psi) is displayed
Analogue output (4 .. 20 mA or 0 .. 10 V)
Programming disable Dimensions:
Cable gland PG 11
Terminal assignment:
Pin
1 +UB
2 0V
3 Analogue output Signal +
4 Analogue output Signal - (0 V)
5 Relay 1 N/C
6 Relay 1 N/O
7 Centre relay 1 and 2
8 Relay 2 N/C
9 Relay 2 N/O
10 Relay 3 N/C G1/4 DIN3852 female
11 Relay 3 N/O countersink to DIN 74-KM5
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
E 18.055.5/11.13
72
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 4400
Programmable
3
Description: Technical data:
The programmable electronic pressure Input data
switch in the series EDS 4400 has been Measuring ranges 40; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
specially developed to combine the Overload pressures 80; 200; 500; 800; 1000 bar
advantages of a compact, robust and Burst pressures 200; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000 bar
cost-effective device with the benefits of Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
a programmable pressure switch. Torque value 20 Nm
The EDS 4400 can be easily Parts in contact with medium Mech. conn.: Stainless steel
programmed using the HPG 3000 Seal: FPM
programming unit. Output data
Once the programming unit is Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
disconnected from the EDS 4400, the Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
pressure switch retains all the settings. Repeatability ≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.
This prevents unauthorised or incorrect Temperature drift ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max. zero point
adjustment of the settings. ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max. range
The following parameters can be Switch output 1 or 2 transistor switch outputs
changed: PNP or NPN
N/C or N/O
Switching point Output load PNP:
Hysteresis max. 1.2 A with 1 switching output
max. 1 A each with 2 switching outputs
Switching direction (N/O / N/C) NPN:
Switching delay times max. 0.5 A with 1 switching output
max. 0.3 A each with 2 switching outputs
The EDS 4400 is suitable for high-
Switching points / Hysteresis user-programmable with HYDAC
pressure applications (starting at Programming Unit HPG 3000
40 bar) and has a pressure Rising switch point and falling switch point delay 8 ms to 2000 ms;
measurement cell with thin-film strain User-programmable with
gauge on a stainless steel membrane. HYDAC Programming Unit HPG 3000
In contrast to pressure switches Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
which are factory-set according to Environmental conditions
customer requirements and are not Compensated temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
field-adjustable, the programmable Operating temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
EDS 4400 is highly versatile and Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
replaces a wide range of models. This
Fluid temperature range1) -40 .. +100 °C/ -25 .. +100 °C
is advantageous in respect of stock
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
management.
mark2) Certificate No. E318391
Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g
Special features: DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Shock resistance to ≤ 100 g
Option of 1 or 2 switching outputs DIN EN 60068-2-29 (1 ms)
Option of PNP or NPN switching Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 67 ( M12x1, when an
outputs IP 67 connector is used)
Other data
High switching output capacity
Supply voltage 8 .. 32 V DC
Accuracy ≤ ± 1 % FS for use acc. to UL spec. - limited energy - according to
Flexible user-programming 9.3 UL 61010; Class 2;
UL 1310/1585; LPS UL 60950
Compact and robust design
Current consumption ≤ 25 mA with inactive switching outputs
Also available in ATEX version for ≤ 1.225 A with 1 switching output
potentially explosive locations ≤ 2.025 A with 2 switching outputs
Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Life expectancy > 10 million cycles, 0 .. 100 % FS
E 18.067.2/11.13
Weight ~ 145 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and
short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to the complete measurement range
1)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
2)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No 61010-1
73
Setting options: Model code:
In conjunction with the HYDAC
Programming Unit HPG 3000, all the EDS 4 4 4 8 – XXXX – X – P X – 000
settings are combined in an easy-to-follow
menu. Mechanical connection
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
Setting ranges for the switch Electrical connection
outputs: 8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole
Measuring range Increment Pressure ranges in bar
in bar in bar 0040; 0100; 0250; 0400; 0600
0 .. 40 0.1 Number of switching outputs
0 .. 100 0.2 1 = 1 switching output
2 = 2 switching outputs
0 .. 250 0.5 Output technology
0 .. 400 1 P = Programmable switching output
0 .. 600 1 Output technology 2
P = PNP switching output
The switch point (upper switch value) N = NPN switching output
on all instruments is between
Modification number
5 % and 100 % of the measuring range
000 = Standard
3 and the switch-back point (lower
switch value) is between 1 % and 96 %
of the measuring range. Note:
For instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or
Minimum Maximum the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
value value
in ms in ms Accessories:
Switch-on Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
delay 8 2040 Accessories brochure.
Ton1/Ton2
Switch-off
delay 8 2040
ToF1/ToF2
The increment for all instruments is
8 ms.
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
E 18.067.2/11.13
74
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 4300
Programmable
3
Description: Technical data:
The programmable electronic pressure Input data
switch in the series EDS 4300 was Measuring ranges 1; 2.5; 6; 10; 16 bar
specially developed to combine the -1 .. 1; -1 .. 9 bar
advantages of a compact, robust and Overload pressures 3; 8; 20; 32; 50 bar
cost-effective instrument with the 3; 32 bar
benefits of a programmable pressure Burst pressures 5; 12; 30; 48; 75 bar
switch. 5, 48 bar
Mechanical connection G1/4 A DIN 3852
The EDS 4300 can be easily
Torque value 20 Nm
programmed using the HPG 3000
Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
programming unit. Sensor cell: Ceramic
Once the programming unit is Seal: FPM / EPDM (as per model code)
disconnected from the EDS 4300, the Output data
pressure switch retains all the settings. Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
This prevents unauthorised or incorrect Max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
adjustment of the settings. Repeatability ≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.
The following parameters can be Temperature drift ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max. zero point
changed: ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max. range
Switch output 1 or 2 transistor switch outputs
Switching point PNP or NPN
Hysteresis N/C or N/O
Output load PNP:
Switching direction (N/O / N/C) max. 1.2 A with 1 switching output
Switching delay times max. 1 A each with 2 switching outputs
NPN:
The EDS 4300 is suitable for low max. 0.5 A on version with 1 switching output
pressure applications (up to 16 bar) and max. 0.3 A each on version with 2 switching outputs
has a pressure measurement cell with Switching points / Hysteresis user-programmable with HYDAC
thick-film strain gauge on a ceramic Programming Unit HPG 3000
membrane. Rising switch point and falling switch point delay 8 ms to 2000 ms;
Freely programmable with
In contrast to pressure switches which HYDAC Programming Unit HPG 3000
are factory-set according to customer Long-term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
requirements and not field-adjustable, Environmental conditions
the programmable EDS 4300 is highly Compensated temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
versatile and replaces a wide range of Operating temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
models. This is advantageous in respect Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
of stock management. Fluid temperature range1) -40 .. +100 °C / -25 .. +100 °C
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
mark2) Certificate No. E318391
Special features: Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g
Option of 1 or 2 switching outputs DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Option of PNP or NPN switching Shock resistance to ≤ 100 g
DIN EN 60068-2-29 (1 ms)
outputs
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 67 ( M12x1, when an IP 67 connector is
High switching output capacity used)
Accuracy ≤ ± 1 % FS Other data
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
E 18.070.0/11.13
76
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 820
with IO-Link Interface
3
Description: Technical data:
EDS 820 with IO-Link communication Input data
interface is a compact electronic Measuring ranges 25; 40; 60; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
pressure switch for relative pressure Overload range 50; 80; 120; 200; 500; 800; 1000 bar
measurement in the high-pressure Burst pressures 100; 200; 300; 500; 1250; 2000; 2000 bar
range. Mechanical connection G¼ A DIN 3852 with 0.5 mm orifice
The device has two PNP transistor
Torque value 20 Nm
switch outputs, one of which can serve
Parts in contact with medium Mech. connection: Stainless steel
as the IO communication output. Seal: FPM
Compared with the standard version, Output data
the IO-Link interface enables Output signals Pin 4: IO Link interface or
bidirectional communication between user-configurable switching output
the device and the control. Pin 2: user-configurable switching output
Parameterisation and cyclical Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
transmission of process and service Max. setting ≤ ± 1.0 % FS max.
data is therefore possible. Repeatability ≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.
The pressure switch series EDS 820 Temperature drift ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max. zero point
with communication interface IO-Link ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max. range
according to specification V1.1 has Switch outputs
been specially designed for connecting Type PNP transistor output
sensors in automation systems. Switching current max. 250 mA per output
Typical fields of application are Switching cycles > 100 million
machine tools, handling and assembly Reaction time < 10 ms
automation, intralogistics or the Long term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
packaging industry. Parameterisation Via IO-Link interface, with HYDAC
programming device HPG 3000
Environmental conditions
Special features: Compensated temperature range -25 .. +85 °C
IO-Link interface or PNP transistor Operating temperature range 1) -40 .. +85 °C / -25 .. +85 °C
switch output Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
1 additional PNP transistor switching Fluid temperature range 1) -40 .. +125 °C / -25 .. +125 °C
output - mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Accuracy ≤ ± 1.0 % FS Vibration resistance acc. to ≤ 25 g
Highly robust sensor cell DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 0 .. 500 Hz
Status LED display for active switch Shock resistance according to ≤ 50 g
DIN EN 60068-2-29 (11 ms)
outputs
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 67 (M12x1 male connection, for use with
an IP 67 connector)
Other data
Supply voltage 10 .. 32 V DC
Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Current consumption ≤ 25 mA with inactive switching outputs
≤ 0.275 A with 1 active switching output
≤ 0.525 A with 2 active switching outputs
Weight ~ 65 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage,
override and short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to the full measuring range
1)
-25 °C for EPM seal, -40 °C on request
E 18.070.1.0/11.13
77
Pin connections: IO-Link-specific data:
Baud rate 38.4 kBaud *
M12x1, 4 pole Cycle time 2.5 ms
Process data width 16 Bit
L+
IO-Link
Frame type 2.2
Specification V1.1
1 C/Q
2 4 *C
onnection with unshielded standard sensor line possible
3 up to a max. line length of 20 m.
Download the IO Device Description (IODD) from:
L- Standard IO http://www.hydac.com/de-en/service/downloads-software-on-request/
I/Q
Model code:
Pin Signal Description EDS 8 2 4 – XXXX – L – 000
1 L+ Supply voltage
2 I/Q Switching output (SP2) / Mechanical connection
analogue output 4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
3 L- Gnd Pressure ranges in bar
0025; 0040; 0060; 0100; 0250; 0400; 0600
4 C/Q IO-Link communication /
switching output (SP1) Output
3 L = IO Link Interface
Modification number
Status LEDs: 000 = Standard
The pressure switch has 3 status LEDs on
the electrical connection: Notes:
2 LEDs (yellow) for the switching statuses On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
of SP1 and SP2 and 1 LED (green) for the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
operating status Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found
in the Accessories brochure.
M12x1
connection
Dimensions:
SP 2 SP 1 Ø 25.9 ±0.30
male elect. conn. M12x1, 4 pole
Com 11.4
(max. 45 +0.3)
4.1
hex. SW27
G1/4 A
orifice Ø 0.5
18.9 -0.2
Ø 23.5 -0.1
Ø 29.4 -0.1
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
E 18.070.1.0/11.13
78
E 18.070.1.0/11.13
79
3
Pressure sensors with flush membranes
Depending on the application and the medium used, it is not always
possible to use standard pressure connections.
This is the case, for example, with media which can cause the standard
pressure connection to become blocked, clogged or frozen, or for
applications where the medium changes frequently and residues can
result in mixing or contamination of the media.
You can find more sensors with flush membranes for special applications
in the Section on "Sensors for potentially explosive atmospheres".
4
E 180.000.2/11.13
80
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4700
with Flush Membrane
Electrical connection
5 = Male, 3 pole + PE, EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
(female connector supplied)
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
(female connector not supplied)
Modification number
000 = Standard
Note:
Special models on request.
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
Pin HDA 47Z6-A HDA 47Z6-B
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
1 Signal+ +UB
Accessories:
2 n.c. n.c.
Appropriate accessories such as female electrical connectors can be found in the
Accessories brochure. 3 Signal- 0V
4 n.c. Signal
Dimensions:
4
hex-SW27
elastomer profile
seal ring
[G01] DIN 3869
hex-SW27 Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
hex-SW27
For applications and operating conditions
hex-SW27
seal ring DIN 3869 not described, please contact the relevant
18.5 x 23.9 x 1.5 seal ring DIN 3869 technical department.
18.5 x 23.9 x 1.5
O-ring 15 x 2
Subject to technical modifications.
O-ring 15 x 2
E 18.374.1/11.13
82
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4400
with Flush Membrane
Weight ~ 150 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override
and short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range, B.F.S.L. = Best Fit Straight Line
1)
G1/2 with additional front O-ring seal max. 1500 bar
2)
Other seal materials on request
3)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
4)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No. 61010-1
83
Model code: Pin connections:
HDA 4 4 Z X – X – XXXX – XXX – 000 EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories such as female electrical connectors can be found Pin HDA 44Z6-A HDA 44Z6-B
in the Accessories brochure.
1 Signal+ +UB
2 n.c. n.c.
Dimensions: 3 Signal- 0V
4 n.c. Signal
profile seal
4 ring
hex-SW27
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN 3869
[G01]
hex-SW27
seal ring DIN 3869
hex-SW27 Note:
18.5 x 23.9 x 1.5
The information in this brochure relates to
[G02] the operating conditions and
O-ring 15 x 2
applications described.
For applications and operating conditions
hex-SW27
hex-SW27 not described, please contact the relevant
seal ring DIN 3869 seal ring DIN 3869 technical department.
2
O-ring 15 x 2
8
84
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4300
with Flush Membrane
Weight ~ 150 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range, B.F.S.L. = Best Fit Straight Line
1)
Other seal materials on request
2)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
3)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No. 61010-1
85
Model code: Pin connections:
HDA 4 3 Z X – X – XXXX – XXX – 000 EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
4
male electr. conn male electr. conn.
3p+PE EN175301-803 (DIN 43650) 4p / 5p
hex-SW27
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869
[G01]
hex-SW27
3
Note:
10
O-ring 15 x 2
Ø 18.1 hex-SW27
G1/2 A
The information in this brochure relates to
Ø 26 h14 the operating conditions and
[G02] Ø 29.5 applications described.
For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
hex-SW27
hex-SW27
seal ring DIN3869
technical department.
11.6 x 16.5 x 1.5 seal ring DIN3869
18.5 x 23.9 x 1.5
Subject to technical modifications.
O-ring 15 x 2
O-ring 7.65 x 1.78
E 18.376.1/11.13
86
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 7400
with Flush Membrane
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override
and short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
B.F.S.L. = Best Fit Straight Line
1)
Other seal materials on request
2)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
3)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No. 61010-1
87
Model code: Pin connections:
HDA 7 4 Z 6 – X XXXX – XXX – 000 M12x1
Dimensions:
4
52.6
52.6
37.5
37.5
2 +0.3
2
G1/4 A
O-ring 7.65 x 1.78
Ø 10.9 Ø 18.9
[G05] Ø 21
G1/4 A
Ø 18.9
[G04] Ø 21
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.376.1.0/11.13
88
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 3400
with Flush Membrane
height of digits 7 mm
Many useful additional functions Weight ~ 120 g
Option of Desina®-compliant Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and short circuit protection are provided.
pin configuration with diagnostic FS (Full Scale) = relative to the full measuring range
1)
G1/2 with additional front O-ring seal max. 1500 bar
function 2)
Other seal materials on request
3)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
4)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No. 61010-1
89
Setting options: Model code:
All settings offered by the EDS 3400 are
grouped in 2 easy-to-navigate menus. EDS 3 4 Z X – X – XXXX – XXX – 000
In order to prevent unauthorised Mechanical process connection
adjustment of the device, a programming Z = Flush membrane
lock can be set. Electrical connection
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
only possible on output models "1", "2" and "3"
Setting ranges for the switch
8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole
outputs: only possible on output model "5"
Switching point function Output
Meas. Switch Hysteresis Incre- 1 = 1 switching output
range point ment* only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
in bar in bar in bar in bar 2 = 2 switching outputs
0 .. 40 0.6 .. 40 0.2 .. 39.6 0.1 only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
3 = 1 switching output and 1 analogue output
0 .. 100 1.6 .. 100 0.6 .. 99.0 0.2 only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
0 .. 250 4.0 .. 250 1.5 .. 247.5 0.5 5 = 2 switching outputs and 1 analogue output
0 .. 400 6.0 .. 400 2.0 .. 396 1 only in conjunction with electrical connection type "8"
Pressure ranges in bar
0 .. 600 9.0 .. 600 3.0 .. 594 1
0040; 0100; 0250; 0400; 0600
Mechanical connection
Window function G01 = G1/2 A DIN 3852
Meas. Lower Upper Incre- G02 = G1/2 with additional front O-ring seal
range switch switch ment* G04 = G1/4 with additional front O-ring seal
value value G05 = G1/4 A DIN 3852
in bar in bar in bar in bar G12 = G1/2 with add. front O-ring seal and cooling section
0 .. 40 0.6 .. 39.2 0.9 .. 39.6 0.1 Modification number
0 .. 100 1.6 .. 98.2 2.4 .. 99 0.2 000 = Standard
0 .. 250 4.0 .. 245.5 6.0 .. 247.5 0.5
0 .. 400 6.0 .. 392 9.0 .. 396 1
0 .. 600 9.0 .. 589 14 .. 594 1 Model code:
* All ranges given in the table DESINA®-compliant or
are adjustable by the increments can be connected to DESINA®:
shown.
90
Dimensions: Pin connections:
installation dimension Ø 53.5
M12x1, 4 pole
housing
turns thru M12x1, 5 pole
340°
4 3
5
hex-SW27
1 2
elastomer
profile gasket
DIN 3869
[G01]
Pin EDS
34Z8-5
1 +UB
2 Analogue
3 0V
4 SP 1 4
hex-SW27 hex-SW27
seal ring DIN3869 seal ring DIN3869 5 SP 2
18.5 x 23.9 x 1.5 11.6 x 16.5 x 1.5
4 3
5
[G02] [G04]
1 2
hex-SW27
hex-SW27
seal ring DIN3869 DESINA®- Can be
18.5 x 23.9 x 1.5 compliant connected to
DESINA®
Pin EDS EDS
hex-SW27 34Z8-1 34Z8-3
[G05]
seal ring DIN3869 1 +UB +UB
18.5 x 23.9 x 1.5
O-ring 15 x 2
2 Diagnostics Diagnostics
3 0V 0V
4 SP 1 SP 1
5 n.c. Analogue
[G12]
Note:
E 18.377.1/11.13
91
4
92
E 18.377.1/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 3300
with Flush Membrane
height of digits 7 mm
Optional Desina®-compliant pin confi- Weight ~ 120 g
guration with diagnostic function Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
1)
Other seal materials on request
2)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
3)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No. 61010-1
93
Setting options: Model code:
All settings offered by the EDS 3300 are
grouped in 2 easy-to-navigate menus. EDS 3 3 Z X – X – XXXX – XXX – 000
In order to prevent unauthorised
adjustment of the device, a programming Mechanical process connection
lock can be set. Z = Flush membrane
Electrical connection
Setting ranges for the switch 6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
outputs: only possible on output models "1", "2" and "3"
8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole
Switching point function only possible on output model "5"
Meas. Switch Hysteresis Incre- Output
range point ment* 1 = 1 switching output
in bar in bar in bar in bar
only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
-1 .. 1 -0.97 .. 1 -0.99 .. 0.98 0.01 2 = 2 switching outputs
0 .. 1 0.016 .. 1 0.006 .. 0.99 0.002 only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
3 = 1 switching output and 1 analogue output
0 .. 2.5 0.04 .. 2.5 0.015 .. 2.475 0.005 only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
0 .. 6 0.09 .. 6 0.3 .. 5.94 0.01 5 = 2 switching outputs and 1 analogue output
only in conjunction with electrical connection type "8"
0 .. 10 0.16 .. 10 0.06 .. 9.9 0.02
Pressure ranges in bar
0 .. 16 0.25 .. 16 0.1 .. 15.8 0.05
01.0; 02.5; 06.0; 0010; 0016
0001 (-1..1)
Window function Mechanical connection
Meas. Lower Upper Incre- G01 = G1/2 A DIN 3852
range switch value switch value ment* G02 = G1/2 with additional front O-ring seal
in bar in bar in bar in bar G04 = G1/4 with additional front O-ring seal
-1 .. 1 -0.97 .. 0.96 -0.95 .. 0.98 0.01 G05 = G1/4 A DIN 3852
G12 = G1/2 with additional front O-ring seal and cooling section
0 .. 1 0.016 .. 0.982 0.024.. 0.99 0.002
Modification number
0 .. 2.5 0.04 .. 2.455 0.06 .. 2.475 0.005 000 = Standard
0 .. 6 0.09 .. 5.89 0.14 .. 5.94 0.01
0 .. 10 0.16 .. 9.82 0.24 .. 9.9 0.02
Model code:
0 .. 16 0.25 .. 15.7 0.4 .. 15.8 0.05
* All ranges given in the table
DESINA®-compliant or
are adjustable by the increments can be connected to DESINA®:
shown.
94
Dimensions: Pin connections:
installation dimension Ø 53.5
M12x1, 4 pole
housing
turns thru M12x1, 5 pole
340°
4 3
5
1 2
hex-SW27
elastomer
profile gasket
DIN 3869
[G01]
Pin EDS
33Z8-5
1 +UB
2 Analogue
3 0V
4 SP 1 4
hex-SW27 hex-SW27
4 3
5
[G02] [G04]
1 2
hex-SW27 hex-SW27
95
ELECTRONIC TEMPERATURE TRANSMITTERS
As with the pressure transmitters, HYDAC ELECTRONIC also has
temperature transmitters appropriate for every application.
The transmitters are available with a variety of output signals, connectors and
fluid port connection options.
Other temperature transmitters for special applications can be found in the sections
"Service Instruments" and "OEM Products for Large Volume Production".
5
E 180.000.2 /11.13
96
Electronic
Temperature Transmitter
ETS 7200
97
Model code: Pin connections:
ETS 7 2 4 6 – X – 010 – 000 M12x1
Mechanical connection
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
Electrical connection
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
(connector not supplied)
Signal
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
B = 0 .. 10 V, 3 conductor Pin ETS 7246-A ETS 7246-B
Probe length 1 Signal+ +UB
010 = 10 mm
2 n.c. n.c.
Modification number
3 Signal- 0V
000 = Standard
4 n.c. Signal
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors can be found
in the Accessories brochure.
Dimensions:
hex.-SW19
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.315.3/11.13
98
Electronic
Temperature Transmitter
ETS 4100
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and
short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
1)
Other seal materials on request
2)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
99
Model code: Pin connections:
ETS 4 1 4 X – X – XXX – 000 Binder series 714 M18
Mechanical connection
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
Electrical connection
4 = Male, 4 pole Binder series 714 M18
(connector not supplied)
5 = Male, 3 pole + PE,
EN 175301-803 (DIN 43650)
(connector supplied) Pin ETS 4144-A ETS 4144-B
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole 1 n.c. +UB
(connector not supplied)
2 Signal+ Signal
Signal
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor 3 Signal - 0V
B = 0 .. 10 V, 3 conductor 4 n.c. n.c.
Probe length
006 = 6 mm EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
050 = 50 mm
100 = 100 mm
250 = 250 mm
350 = 350 mm
Modification number
000 = Standard
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the Pin ETS 4145-A ETS 4145-B
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument. 1 Signal+ +UB
2 Signal- 0V
Accessories: 3 n.c. Signal
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors can be found
^ Housing Housing
in the Accessories brochure.
M12x1
Dimensions:
5
Pin ETS 4146-A ETS 4146-B
1 Signal+ +UB
2 n.c. n.c.
3 Signal- 0V
hex.-SW27 4 n.c. Signal
elastomer
profile seal ring
Note:
DIN3869
100
Electronic
Temperature Transmitter
ETS 4500
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and
short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
1)
Other seal materials on request
2)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
101
Model code: Pin connections:
ETS 4 5 4 X – X – XXX – 000 EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
Mechanical connection
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
Electrical connection
5 = Male, 3 pole + PE,
EN 175301-803 (DIN 43650)
(connector supplied)
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
(connector not supplied)
Pin ETS 4545-A ETS 4545-B
Signal
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor 1 Signal+ +UB
B = 0 .. 10 V, 3 conductor 2 Signal- 0V
Probe length 3 n.c. Signal
010 = 10 mm ^ Housing Housing
050 = 50 mm
100 = 100 mm
250 = 250 mm M12x1
350 = 350 mm
Modification number
000 = Standard
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Dimensions:
hex.-SW27
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
Probe length Probe diameter
Probe length Probe diameter described.
(Z) (Z) [mm]
[mm] [mm] [mm]
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
10.7 10.7 8 8 technical department.
50 50 8 8 Subject to technical modifications.
100 100 8 8
E 18.302.2.0/11.13
102
E 18.302.2.0/11.13
5
103
ELECTRONIC TEMPERATURE SWITCHES
For measuring and monitoring the temperature of the medium, HYDAC
offers a wide variety of electronic temperature switches with an integrated
or separate temperature probe.
Page
ETS 3200 Pressure-resistant for inline installation 105
ETS 3200 Pressure-resistant for inline installation, 107
menu navigation to VDMA
ETS 3200 Pressure-resistant for inline installation, IO-Link 109
ETS 3200 for tank installation 111
ETS 3200 for tank installation, menu navigation to VDMA 113
ETS 3200 for tank installation, IO-Link 115
ETS 3800 for separate temperature probe 117
ETS 3800 for separate temperature probe, 119
menu navigation to VDMA
ETS 3800 for separate temperature probe, IO-Link 121
ETS 320 Pressure-resistant for inline installation 123
ETS 380 for separate temperature probe 125
ETS 1700 for separate temperature probe 127
TFP 100 (separate temperature probe) 129
ETS 3800
ETS 1700
ETS 320
ETS 380
Electronic
Temperature Switches
UL Approval ü ü
Note:
Not all feature combinations are possible. For precise information, please consult the relevant
data sheet.
104
Electronic Temperature
Switch
ETS 3200 Pressure Resistant
for Inline Mounting
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and
short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
1)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
2)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No 61010-1
105
Setting options: Model code:
All the settings available on the ETS 3200
are combined in 2 easy-to-navigate menus. ETS 3 2 2 X – X – 018 – 000
To prevent unauthorised adjustment of the
instrument, a programming lock can be Mechanical connection
set. 2 = G1/2 A DIN 3852 (male)
Electrical connection
Setting ranges of the 6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
switching points and only possible on output models "2" and "3"
switch-back hystereses: 8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole
Switching point function only possible on output model "5"
Unit Switching Hysteresis Incre- Output
point ment* 2 = 2 switching outputs
only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
°C -23.0 .. 100.0 1.0 .. 123.5 0.5
3 = 1 switching output and 1 analogue output
°F -9 .. 212 2 .. 222 1 only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
5 = 2 switching outputs and 1 analogue output
Window function only in conjunction with electrical connection type "8"
Unit Lower Upper Incre- Probe length in mm
switch value switch value ment* 018
°C -23.0 .. 97.5 -22.0 .. 98.5 0.5 Modification number
°F -9 .. 208 -7 .. 209 1 000 = Standard
* All ranges given in the table are
adjustable by the increments shown. Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label
Additional functions: or the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Switching mode of the switching outputs
adjustable (switching point function or
window function) Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, splash guards, etc. can be
Switching direction of the switching outputs found in the Accessories brochure.
adjustable (N/C or N/O)
Switch-on and switch-off delay
adjustable from 0.00 .. 99.99 seconds
Choice of display (actual temperature,
peak temperature, switching point 1,
Dimensions:
switching point 2, display off)
1 +UB +UB
O-ring 20.35x1.78-NBR
2 SP 2 Analogue
6
3 0V 0V
4 SP 1 SP 1
4 3
5
1 2
106
Electronic
Temperature Switch
ETS 3200 Pressure Resistant
for Inline Installation
with Menu Navigation to VDMA
107
Setting options: Model code:
All terms and symbols used for setting the
ETS 3200 as well as the menu structure ETS 3 2 2 6 – X – 018 – V00
comply with the specifications in the
VDMA Standard (VDMA 24574-2) for Type
temperature switches. 2 = With integrated temperature sensor
The ETS 3200 can easily be adjusted via Mechanical connection
three push-buttons. 2 = G1/2 A DIN 3852, (male)
Electrical connection
Setting ranges for the switch 6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
outputs: Output
2 = 2 switching outputs
Measuring Lower limit of Upper limit of 3 = 1 switching output and 1 analogue output
range RP / FL SP / FH
Probe length in mm
-25 .. +100 °C -23.8 °C 100.0 °C
018
-13 .. +212 °F -11 °F 212 °F
Modification number
V00 = Menu navigation in accordance with VDMA (Standard 24574-2)
Measuring Min. difference Increment* Notes:
range betw.
RP and SP On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
& FL and FH technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
-25 .. +100 °C 1.2 °C 0.2 °C Accessories:
-13 .. + 212 °F 2 °F 1 °F Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, mechanical adapters, splash
guards, clamps for wall-mounting etc can be found in the Accessories brochure.
* All ranges given in the table
are adjustable by the increments
shown.
SP = switch point Dimensions:
RP = switch-back point
FL = temperature window lower value Ø 42
40.4
25.2
FH = temperature window upper value M12x1 11
270°
adjustable (switching point function or
window function)
16.1
92.5
Switching direction of the switching
340°
Choice of display (current temperature,
peak temperature, switching point 1,
hex. SW27
14
Pin connections: Ø6
Ø 7.5
16.1
G1/2 A
Ø 26 h14
Ø 29.5
M12x1, 4 pole
installation dimension Ø 53.5
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
E 18.327.1.0/11.13
108
Electronic
Temperature Switch
ETS 3200 – Pressure-Resistant
for Inline Installation
with IO-Link Interface
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and
short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
1)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
109
Setting options: IO-Link-specific data:
All terms and symbols used for setting the Baud rate 38.4 kBaud *
ETS 3200 as well as the menu structure Cycle time 2.5 ms
comply with the specifications in the Process data width 16 Bit
VDMA Standard for temperature switches. Frame type 2.2
Specification V1.1
Setting ranges for the switch *C
onnection with unshielded standard sensor line possible
outputs: up to a max. line length of 20 m.
Download the IO Device Description (IODD) from:
Measuring Lower limit of Upper limit of http://www.hydac.com/de-en/service/downloads-software-on-request/
range RP / FL SP / FH
-25 .. +100 °C
-13 .. +212 °F
-23.8 °C
-11 °F
100.0 °C
212 °F
Model code:
ETS 3 2 2 6 – L – 018 – 000
Measuring Min. difference Increment* Type
range betw. 2 = With integrated temperature sensor
RP and SP
& FL and FH Mechanical connection
-25 .. +100 °C 1.2 °C 0.2 °C 2 = G1/2 A DIN 3852, (male)
-13 .. + 212 °F 2 °F 1 °F Electrical connection
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
* All ranges given in the table are (connector not supplied)
adjustable by the increments shown.
Output
SP = switch point
RP = switch-back point L = IO Link interface
FL = temperature window lower value Probe length in mm
FH = temperature window upper value 018
Modification number
Additional functions: 000 = Standard
Switching mode of the switching outputs Notes:
adjustable (switching point function or On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
window function) technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Switching direction of the switching Accessories:
outputs adjustable (N/C or N/O function) Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, mechanical adapters, splash
Switch-on and switch-off delay guards, clamps for wall-mounting etc can be found in the Accessories brochure.
adjustable from 0.00 .. 99.99 seconds
Choice of display (current temperature,
peak temperature, switching point 1,
switching point 2, display off) Dimensions:
Ø 42
Pin connections: 25.2
M12x1 11
40.4
M12x1, 4 pole
270°
L+
IO-Link
16.1
1 C/Q
2 4
76
65
3
340°
L- Standard IO
3 +0.2
I/Q
14
hex. SW27
O-ring 20.35x1.78-NBR
18
5
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
E 18.327.2.0/11.13
110
Electronic
Temperature Switch
ETS 3200
for Tank Installation
Pin connections:
M12x1, 4 pole
housing turns thru 340°
Probe
O-ring 20.35x1.78-NBR
4 SP 1 SP 1 300
4 3
5
1 2
112
Electronic
Temperature Switch
ETS 3200 for Tank Installation
with Menu Navigation to VDMA
113
Setting options: Model code:
All terms and symbols used for setting the
ETS 3200 as well as the menu structure ETS 3 2 2 6 – X – XXX – V00
comply with the specifications in the
VDMA Standard (VDMA 24574-2) for Type
temperature switches. 2 = With integrated temperature sensor
The ETS 3200 can easily be adjusted via Mechanical connection
three push-buttons. 2 = G1/2 A DIN 3852 (male)
Electrical connection
Setting ranges for the 6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
switching outputs: Output
2 = 2 switching outputs
Measuring Lower limit of Upper limit of 3 = 1 switching output and 1 analogue output
range RP / FL SP / FH
-25 .. +100 °C -23.8 °C 100.0 °C Probe length in mm
-13 .. +212 °F -11 °F 212 °F
100; 250; 350
Modification number
V00 = Menu navigation in accordance with VDMA (Standard 24574-2)
Measuring Min. difference Increment*
range betw. Notes:
RP and SP On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
& FL and FH technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
-25 .. +100 °C 1.2 °C 0.2 °C Accessories:
-13 .. + 212 °F 2 °F 1 °F Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, mechanical adapters, splash
* All ranges given in the table guards, clamps for wall-mounting etc can be found in the Accessories brochure.
are adjustable by the increments
shown.
SP = switch point
RP = switch-back point Dimensions:
Ø 42
FL = temperature window lower value 25.2 40.4
Additional functions:
270°
Switching mode of the switching outputs
adjustable (switching point function or
16.1
window function)
340°
+0.2
100
O-ring 20.35x1.78-NBR
300
Pin connections: Ø8 16.1
G1/2 A
Ø 26 h14
Ø 29.5
M12x1, 4 pole
installation dimension Ø 53.5
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
E 18.319.1.0/11.13
114
Electronic
Temperature Switch
ETS 3200 for Tank Installation
with IO-Link Interface
Weight (complete unit including probe) ~ 150 g (probe length 100 mm)
~ 185 g (probe length 250 mm)
~ 210 g (probe length 350 mm)
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage,
override and short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
1)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
115
Setting options: IO-Link-specific data:
All terms and symbols used for setting the Baud rate 38.4 kBaud *
ETS 3200 as well as the menu structure Cycle time 2.5 ms
comply with the specifications in the Process data width 16 Bit
VDMA Standard for temperature switches. Frame type 2.2
Specification V1.1
Setting ranges for the switch *C
onnection with unshielded standard sensor line possible
outputs: up to a max. line length of 20 m.
Download the IO Device Description (IODD) from:
Measuring Lower limit of Upper limit of http://www.hydac.com/de-en/service/downloads-software-on-request/
range RP / FL SP / FH
-25 .. +100 °C
-13 .. +212 °F
-23.8 °C
-11 °F
100.0 °C
212 °F
Model code:
ETS 3 2 2 6 – L – XXX – 000
Measuring Min. difference Increment* Type
range betw. 2 = With integrated temperature probe
RP and SP
& FL and FH Mechanical connection
-25 .. +100 °C 1.2 °C 0.2 °C 2 = G1/2 A DIN 3852, (male)
-13 .. + 212 °F 2 °F 1 °F Electrical connection
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
* All ranges given in the table are (connector not supplied)
adjustable by the increments shown.
Output
SP = switch point
RP = switch-back point L = IO Link interface
FL = temperature window lower value Probe length in mm
FH = temperature window upper value 100; 250; 350
Modification number
Additional functions: 000 = Standard
Switching mode of the switching outputs Notes:
adjustable (switching point function or
window function) On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Switching direction of the switching
outputs adjustable (N/C or N/O function) Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, mechanical adapters, splash
Switch-on and switch-off delay
guards, clamps for wall-mounting etc can be found in the Accessories brochure.
adjustable from 0.00 .. 99.99 seconds
Choice of display (current temperature,
peak temperature, switching point 1,
switching point 2, display off)
Dimensions:
Ø 42
Pin connections: 25.2 40.4
L+
16.1
IO-Link
housing turns thru
92.5
1 C/Q
2 4
76
65
3
340°
+0.2
I/Q (dim. Z)
hex. SW27
14
2
100
O-ring 20.35x1.78-NBR
Ø 9.4
250
Z
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
E 18.319.2.0/11.13
116
Electronic
Temperature Switch
ETS 3800
for Separate Temperature Probe
117
Setting options: Model code:
All the settings available on the ETS 3800
are combined in 2 easy-to-navigate menus. ETS 3 8 6 X – X – 000 – 000
To prevent unauthorised adjustment of the
instrument, a programming lock can be Mechanical connection
set. 6 = Female cable connection M12x1, 4 pole
Electrical connection
Setting ranges of the 6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
switching points and only possible on output models "2" and "3"
switch-back hystereses: 8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole
Switching point function only possible on output model "5"
Unit Switching Hysteresis Incre- Output
point ment* 2 = 2 switching outputs
only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
°C -27.0 .. 150.0 1.0 .. 178.0 0.5
3 = 1 switching output and 1 analogue output
°F -17 .. 302 2 .. 320 1 only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
5 = 2 switching outputs and 1 analogue output
Window function only in conjunction with electrical connection type "8"
Unit Lower Upper Incre- Probe length in mm
switch value switch value ment* 000 = Separate temperature probe
°C -27.0 .. 146.5 -25.5 .. 148.0 0.5 Modification number
°F -17 .. 296 -14 .. 298 1 000 = Standard
* All ranges given in the table are Note:
adjustable by the increments shown. On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label
or the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Additional functions: Accessories:
Switching mode of the switching outputs A male cable connector M12x1, 4 pole, to connect the separate temperature probe
adjustable (switching point function or and a 3 m sensor cable, LIYCY 4 x 0.25 mm² are supplied with the instrument.
window function) Other accessories, such as electrical connectors, splash guards, clamps for wall-
Switching direction of the switching outputs mounting, etc. can be found in the Accessories brochure.
adjustable (N/C or N/O)
Switch-on and switch-off delay Separate temperature probe:
adjustable from 0.00 .. 99.99 seconds (not supplied with the instrument)
Choice of display (actual temperature, TFP 106 - 000 with electr. conn. 4-pol. M12x1 Part No.: 921330
peak temperature, switching point 1, (connector not supplied)
switching point 2, display off) Tank installation sleeve for TFP 100 Part No.: 906170
Pin connections:
M12x1, 4 pole
Dimensions: display turns thru 270°
housing turns thru 340°
4 3
5
1 2
118
Electronic
Temperature Switch
ETS 3800
for Separate Temperature Probe
with Menu Navigation to VDMA
119
Setting options: Model code:
All terms and symbols used for setting the
ETS 3800 as well as the menu structure ETS 3 8 6 6 – X – 000 – V00
comply with the specifications in the
VDMA Standard (VDMA 24574-2) for Type
temperature switches. 8 = For separate temperature probe
The ETS 3800 can easily be adjusted via Mechanical connection
three push-buttons. 6 = Female cable connection M12x1, 4 pole
Electrical connection
Setting ranges for the switch 6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
outputs: Output
2 = 2 switching outputs
Measurement Lower limit of Upper limit of 3 = 1 switching output and 1 analogue output
range RP / FL SP / FH
-30 .. +150 °C -28.0 °C 150.0 °C Probe length in mm
-22 .. +302 °F -19 °F 302 °F
000 = Separate temperature sensor
Modification number
V00 = Menu navigation in accordance with VDMA (Standard 24574-2)
Measurement Min. difference Increment*
range betw. Notes:
RP and SP On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
& FL and FH technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
-30 .. +150 °C 2.0 °C 0.5 °C Accessories:
-22 .. + 302 °F 3 °F 1 °F A male cable connector M12x1, 4 pole, to connect the separate temperature probe, and
* All ranges given in the table are a 3 m sensor cable, LIYCY 4 x 0.25 mm² are supplied with the instrument.
adjustable by the increments shown. Other accessories, such as electrical connectors, splash guards, clamps for wall-
SP = switch point mounting, etc. can be found in the Accessories brochure.
RP = switch-back point
FL = temperature window lower value Separate temperature probe:
FH = temperature window upper value
(not supplied with the instrument)
TFP 106 - 000 with male electr. conn. 4 pole M12x1 Part No.: 921330
Additional functions: (connector not supplied)
Switching mode of the switching outputs
adjustable (switching point function or Tank installation sleeve for TFP 100 Part No.: 906170
window function)
Switching direction of the switching
outputs adjustable (N/C or N/O function)
Switch-on and switch-off delay
Dimensions:
adjustable from 0.00 .. 99.99 seconds Ø 42
Choice of display (current temperature, 25.2 40.4
M12x1 11
peak temperature, switching point 1,
93.2
M12x1, 4 pole
76.7
65.7
340°
M12x1
electr. conn. female 4 pole 16.1
Ø 22
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
E 18.328.1.0/11.13
120
Electronic
Temperature Switch
ETS 3800
for Separate Temperature Probe
with IO-Link Interface
121
Setting options: IO-Link-specific data:
All terms and symbols used for setting the Baud rate 38.4 kBaud *
ETS 3800 as well as the menu structure Cycle time 2.5 ms
comply with the specifications in the Process data width 16 Bit
VDMA Standard for temperature switches. Frame type 2.2
Specification V1.1
Setting ranges for the switch *C
onnection with unshielded standard sensor line possible
outputs: up to a max. line length of 20 m.
Download the IO Device Description (IODD) from:
Measurement Lower limit of Upper limit of http://www.hydac.com/de-en/service/downloads-software-on-request/
range RP / FL SP / FH
-30 .. +150 °C -28.0 °C 150.0 °C
-22 .. +302 °F -19 °F 302 °F Model code:
ETS 3 8 6 6 – L – 000 – 000
Measuring Min. difference Increment*
range betw. Type
RP and SP 8 = For separate temperature probe
& FL and FH
Mechanical connection
-30 .. +150 °C 2.0 °C 0.5 °C
6 = Female cable connection M12x1, 4 pole
-22 .. + 302 °F 3 °F 1 °F
Electrical connection
* All ranges given in the table are 6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
adjustable by the increments shown. (connector not supplied)
SP = switch point Output
RP = switch-back point
L = IO Link interface
FL = temperature window lower value
FH = temperature window upper value Sensor length in mm
000 = Separate temperature probe
Additional functions: Modification number
Switching mode of the switching outputs 000 = Standard
adjustable (switching point function or Notes:
window function)
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
Switching direction of the switching technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
outputs adjustable (N/C or N/O function)
Accessories:
Switch-on and switch-off delay A male cable connector M12x1, 4 pole, to connect the separate temperature sensor
adjustable from 0.00 .. 99.99 seconds and a 3 m sensor cable, LIYCY 4 x 0.25 mm² are supplied with the instrument.
Choice of display (actual temperature, Other accessories, such as electrical connectors, splash guards, clamps for wall-
peak temperature, switching point 1, mounting, etc. can be found in the Accessories brochure.
switching point 2, display off)
L+
IO-Link
270°
1 C/Q
2 4
3
16.1
93.2
L-
housing turns thru
Standard IO
76.7
65.7
I/Q
340°
122
Electronic
Temperature Switch
ETS 320 Pressure-Resistant
for Inline Installation
123
Setting options: Model code:
All the settings available on the ETS 320
are combined in 2 easy-to-navigate menus. ETS 3 2 X – X – 100 – X00
To prevent unauthorised adjustment of the
instrument, a programming lock can be Mechanical connection
set. 2 = G1/2 A DIN 3852 (male)
Electrical connection
Setting ranges of the 6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
switching points and only possible on output models "2" and "3"
switch-back hystereses: 8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole
Switching point function only possible on output model "5"
Unit Switching Hysteresis Incre- Output
point ment* 2 = 2 switching outputs
only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
°C -22.0 .. 100.0 1.0 .. 178.0 1.0
3 = 1 switching output and 1 analogue output
°F -10.0 .. 212.0 2.0 .. 320.0 2.0 only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
5 = 2 switching outputs and 1 analogue output
Window function only in conjunction with electrical connection type "8"
Unit Lower Upper Incre- Measuring range
switch value switch value ment* -25 .. +100 °C (-13 .. +212 °F)
°C -23.0 .. 99.0 -22.0 .. 100.0 1.0 Modification number
°F -12.0 .. 210.0 -10.0 .. 212.0 2.0 000 = Display in °C
400 = Display in °F
* All ranges given in the table are
adjustable by the increments shown.
Additional functions: Note:
Switching mode of the switching outputs On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label
adjustable (switching point function or or the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
window function)
Accessories:
Switching direction of the switching outputs Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, clamps for wall-mounting, etc.
adjustable (N/C or N/O) can be found in the Accessories brochure.
Switch-on and switch-off delay
adjustable from 0 .. 750 seconds
Choice of display (actual temperature,
peak temperature, switching point 1, Dimensions:
switching point 2, display off)
M12x1, 4 pole
M12x1, 5 pole
4 3
5
1 2
124
Electronic
Temperature Switch
ETS 380
for Separate Temperature Probe
125
Setting options: Model code:
All the settings available on the
ETS 380 are combined in 2 easy-to- ETS 3 8 X – X – 150 – X00
navigate menus.
To prevent unauthorised adjustment of the Mechanical connection
device, a programming lock can be set. 8 = Electrical connection for separate temperature probe
Electrical connection
Setting ranges of the 6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
switching points and only possible on output models "2" and "3"
switch-back hystereses: 8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole
Switching point function only possible on output model "5"
Unit Switching Hysteresis Incre- Output
point ment* 2 = 2 switching outputs
only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
°C -27.0 .. 150.0 1.0 .. 178.0 1.0
3 = 1 switching output and 1 analogue output
°F -16.0 .. 302.0 2.0 .. 320.0 2.0 only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
5 = 2 switching outputs and 1 analogue output
Window function only in conjunction with electrical connection type "8"
Unit Lower Upper Incre- Measuring range
switch value switch value ment* -30 .. +150 °C (-22 .. +302 °F)
°C -28.0 .. 149.0 -27.0 .. 150.0 1.0 Modification number
°F -18.0 .. 300.0 -16.0 .. 302.0 2.0 000 = Display in °C
400 = Display in °F
* All ranges given in the table are
adjustable by the increments shown. Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label
Additional functions: or the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Switching mode of the switching outputs Accessories:
adjustable (switching point function or A male cable connection M12x1, 4 pole, to connect the separate temperature probe
window function) and a 3 m sensor cable, LIYCY 4 x 0.5 mm² are supplied with the instrument.
Switching direction of the switching outputs Other accessories, such as electrical connectors, clamps for wall-mounting, etc. can
adjustable (N/C or N/O) be found in the Accessories brochure.
Switch-on and switch-off delay
adjustable from 0 .. 750 seconds Separate temperature probe:
Choice of display (actual temperature, (not supplied with the instrument)
TFP 104 - 000 with male electr. conn. 4 pole Binder series 714 M18 Part no. 904969
peak temperature, switching point 1,
(connector not supplied)
TFP 106 - 000 with male electr. conn. 4 pole M12x1 Part no. 921330
switching point 2, display off) (connector not supplied)
Tank installation sleeve for TFP 100 Part no. 906170
Pin connections:
M12x1, 4 pole
Dimensions:
M12x1, 5 pole
4 3
5
M12x1
1 2
126
Electronic
Temperature Switch
ETS 1700
127
Setting options: Model code:
The microprocessor integrated into the
ETS 1700 enables many useful extra ETS 1 7 0 X – 100 – 000
functions in addition to the switching
functions, when compared with a normal Type of sensor
mechanical temperature switch. 0 = For PT 100 sensors
It is possible, for example, to activate Display
switching delay times or to change the
1 = 4-digit display °C
relay switching direction.
2 = 4-digit display °F
All settings are made via the keypad.
Measuring range
Setting ranges of the 0 .. 100 °C, (+32 .. 212 °F)
switching points and Modification number
switch-back hystereses: 000 = Standard
Switching point relays 1 to 4:
1.5 .. 100 % of the measuring range
Switching point relays 1 to 4: Note:
1 .. 99 % of the measuring range On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label
or alternatively or the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Switch-back hystereses 1 to 4: Accessories:
1.. 99 % of the measuring range PG cable glands, mounting bolts, a 5 pole female connector (Binder series 681) for
connecting the separate temperature probe and a 3 m sensor cable
Additional functions: (LIYCY 4 x 0.25 mm²) are supplied with the instrument.
Switching direction of the relays 1 to 4 Other accessories, such as vibration mounts etc. can be found in the Accessories
(N/C or N/O function) brochure.
Switch-on delay relays 1 to 4 in the Separate temperature probe:
range from 0.0 .. 900.0 seconds
(not supplied with the instrument)
Switch-off delay relays 1 to 4 in the
range from 0.0 .. 900.0 seconds TFP 104 - 000 with male electr. conn. 4 pole Binder series 714 M18 Part No.: 904696
(female connector supplied)
Switch-back mode TFP 106 - 000 with male electr. conn. 4 pole M12x1 Part No.: 921330
(alternatively switch-back point or (female connector not supplied)
switch-back hysteresis) Tank installation sleeve for TFP 100 Part. No.: 906170
Display of the actual temperature, a
switching point or of the peak value
Display range individually selectable
in °C or °F
Measurement unit (°C, °F) is displayed Dimensions:
Analogue output (4 .. 20 mA or 0 .. 10 V)
Programming lock
Device connection
Pin
1 +UB
2 0V
3 Analogue output Signal +
4 Analogue output Signal - (0 V)
5 Relay 1 N/C
6 Relay 1 N/O
6 7 Centre relay 1 and 2
8 Relay 2 N/C
9 Relay 2 N/O
10 Relay 3 N/C
11 Relay 3 N/O
connector female
12 Centre relay 3 and 4 Binder series 681 -5p
13 Relay 4 N/C
14 Relay 4 N/O
Probe connection
Pin
Note:
1 +UB The information in this brochure relates to
2 Signal + the operating conditions and applications
E 18.303.4/11.13
128
Temperature Probe
TFP 100
Male connection
4 pole
Binder, Series 714 Note:
or M12x1
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
E 18.330.2/11.13
129
Sensors for distance and position
Using various measuring techniques, HYDAC offers different distance and
7 position sensors for a wide array of mobile and stationary applications.
Linear position sensors operate on the physical principle of
magnetostriction.
This measuring principle determines with high accuracy the position,
distance and/or speed signal, if required, and is based on elapsed time
measurement.
Utilizing this non-contact and wear-free measuring technique, HYDAC
offers different versions in a pressure-resistant stainless steel housing for
part or full integration in hydraulic cylinders.
HLT 2100-R1
HLT 2500-F1
HLT 2500-L2
2015 / 2020
IES 2010 /
HLS 528
HLS 100
HLS 200
IWE 40
Sensors for
distance and position
50 to 50 to 50 to 50 to up to
Measurement range in mm
2,500 4,000 4,000 4,000 6,000
For cylinder installation ü ü
Number of switching outputs 2 2 1 (PWM) 2
Analogue output ü ü ü ü ü ü
CANopen Version ü ü ü ü
Device Net ü ü ü
Profibus ü ü ü
EtherCAT ü ü ü
SSI ü ü ü
Available as individual units ü ü ü ü ü
OEM product for large
ü ü ü ü
E 180.000.2 /11.13
volume production
130
7
1)
Other versions are possible.
131
Model code: Pin connections:
7
Mobile HLT 1 1 0 0 – R2 – XXX – XXX – XXXX – 000 Cable outlet
Design/Geometry type
1 = Rod
Mechanical connection
R2 = Cylinder-integrated
Electrical connection
Cable output
K01 = Flying lead, length 1 m Core Analogue CANopen
K02 = Flying lead, length 2 m
K05 = Flying lead, length 5 m brown +UB +UB
K10 = Flying lead, length 10 m white 0V 0V
Signal output
C01 = Analogue 4 .. 20 mA, 3 conductor
C02 = Analogue 20 .. 4 mA, 3 conductor
B01 = Analogue 0 .. 10 V
B02 = Analogue 10 .. 0 V
G01 = Analogue 0.25 .. 4.75 V
G02 = Analogue 4.75 .. 0.25 V
CAN = CANopen
Pin
Measuring range in mm (50 to 2500 mm) 1 +UB
Example
0150 = 150 mm 2 n.c.
3 0V
Modification
000 = Standard 4 Signal
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as position magnets, etc. can be found in the
Accessories section of the Electronics brochure. Pin Signal Description
The recommended position magnet ZBL MR33, part no. 6084207, must be 1 n.c.
ordered separately.
2 +UB supply+
3 0V supply-
Dimensions: 4 CAN_H bus line dominant high
5 CAN_L bus line dominant low
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
Damping zone Measuring length Zero position
HYDAC electronic GmbH
E 18.372.3/11.13
132
7
133
Model code:
7
Stationary HLT 2 1 0 0 – R1 – XXX – XXX – XXXX – 000
Design/Geometry type
1 = Rod
Mechanical connection
R1 = Threaded flange M18x1.5
Electrical connection
Signal output analogue
K01 = Flying lead, length 1 m
M06 = Male M16, 6 pole
M08 = Male M16, 8 pole
Signal output
C01 = Analogue 4 .. 20 mA, 3 conductor
C02 = Analogue 20 .. 4 mA, 3 conductor
B01 = Analogue 0 .. 10 V
B02 = Analogue 10 .. 0 V
ETC = EtherCAT
SSI = Synchronous Serial Interface
CAN = CANopen
PRO = Profibus
DVN = Device Net
Modification
000 = Standard
Notes:
Special models on request. On instruments with a different modification number,
please read the label or the technical amendment details supplied with the
instrument.
Items supplied:
• HLT 2100-R1
• Installation instructions German/English
• HLT 2000 CD incl. case
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as position magnets, etc. can be found in the
Accessories section of the Electronics brochure. The recommended position
magnet ZBL MR33, part no. 6084207, must be ordered separately.
E 18.373.2/11.13
134
Dimensions:
Signal output: analogue (K01)
Rod length
7
SW46
Flying leads
Signal output: CANopen 5 pole male panel mount series M12 A-coded
Device Net (C61)
12 pole CONTACT
Note:
E 18.373.2/11.13
135
7
136
E 18.373.2/11.13
7
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage and excess voltage protection are
provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to the complete measuring range
1)
Other versions are possible.
137
Model code:
7
Stationary HLT 2 5 0 0 – F1 – XXX – XXX – XXXX – 000
Design/Geometry type
5 = Profile
Mechanical connection
F1 = Flat housing
Electrical connection
Signal output analogue
K01 = Flying lead, length 1 m
M06 = Male M16, 6 pole
M08 = Male M16, 8 pole
Signal output CANopen, Device Net
C61 = Female M12x1, 5 pole + male M12x1, 5 pole
Signal output Profibus
P61 = Female M12x1, 5 pole + male M12x1, 5 pole
+ male M8, 4 pole
Signal output Synchronous Serial Interface
S01 = CONTACT male, 12 pole
Signal output EtherCAT
E51 = 2 female M12x1, 4 pole + male M8, 4 pole
Signal output
C01 = Analogue 4 .. 20 mA, 3 conductor
C02 = Analogue 20 .. 4 mA, 3 conductor
B01 = Analogue 0 .. 10 V
B02 = Analogue 10 .. 0 V
ETC = EtherCAT
SSI = Synchronous Serial Interface
CAN = CANopen
PRO = Profibus
DVN = Device Net
Modification
000 = Standard
Notes:
Special models on request. On instruments with a different modification number,
please read the label or the technical amendment details supplied with the
instrument.
Items supplied:
• HLT 2500-F1
• Installation instructions German/English
• HLT 2000 CD incl. case
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as position magnets, etc. can be found in the
Accessories section of the Electronics brochure. The recommended position
magnet ZBL MF 38-18, part no. 6084456, must be ordered separately.
E 18.396.1/11.13
138
Dimensions:
Signal output: analogue (K01)
7
Rod length
Damping zone = 65 Measuring range Zero pos. = 75
Flying leads
adjustable Optional
Note:
E 18.396.1/11.13
139
7
140
E 18.396.1/11.13
7
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage and excess voltage protection are
provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to the complete measuring range
1)
Other versions are possible.
141
Model code:
7
Stationary HLT 2 5 0 0 – L2 – XXX – XXX – XXXX – 000
Design/Geometry type
5 = Profile
Mechanical connection
L2 = With magnet in position slide V
Electrical connection
Signal output analogue
K01 = Flying lead, length 1 m
M06 = Male M16, 6 pole
M08 = Male M16, 8 pole
Signal output CANopen, Device Net
C61 = Female M12x1, 5 pole + male M12x1, 5 pole
Signal output Profibus
P61 = Female M12x1, 5 pole + male M12x1, 5 pole
+ male M8, 4 pole
Signal output Synchronous Serial Interface
S01 = CONTACT male, 12 pole
Signal output EtherCAT
E51 = 2 female M12x1, 4 pole + male M8, 4 pole
Signal output
C01 = Analogue 4 .. 20 mA, 3 conductor
C02 = Analogue 20 .. 4 mA, 3 conductor
B01 = Analogue 0 .. 10 V
B02 = Analogue 10 .. 0 V
ETC = EtherCAT
SSI = Synchronous Serial Interface
CAN = CANopen
PRO = Profibus
DVN = Device Net
Modification
000 = Standard
Notes:
Special models on request. On instruments with a different modification number,
please read the label or the technical amendment details supplied with the
instrument.
Items supplied:
• HLT 2500-L2
• ZBL MS35-39, position magnet
• Installation instructions German/English
• HLT 2000 CD incl. case
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as position magnets and mounting material can be
found in the Accessories section of the Electronics brochure.
E 18.397.1/11.13
142
Dimensions:
Signal output: analogue (K01)
7
Rod length
Flying leads
adjustable
Note:
E 18.397.1/11.13
143
7
144
E 18.397.1/11.13
7
Electronic
Distance Sensor
HLS 528
145
Setting options: Operational scanning range 350 mm: Additional functions:
All the settings available on the Switching mode of the switching
7 HLS 528 are grouped in two easy-to- outputs adjustable (switching point
navigate menus. function or window function)
In order to prevent unauthorised Switching direction of the switching
adjustment of the instrument, a key-lock Plate
outputs adjustable (N/C or
can be set. N/O function)
Switch-on delay adjustable from
Round bar
Ø 10 mm
0 to 20 seconds
Setting ranges of the Energy saving mode
switching points and
switch-back hystereses: Pin connections:
Switching point function distance M12x1, 5 pole
Oper. Switching Hysteresis*
scanning point*
range 4 3
5
250 mm 30 .. 350 mm 1 .. 320 mm
350 mm 85 .. 600 mm 1 .. 515 mm
Operational scanning range 1300 mm: 1 2
1300 mm 200 .. 999 mm 1 .. 999 mm
100 .. 200 cm 100 .. 180 cm
3400 mm 350 .. 999 mm 1 .. 999 mm
100 .. 500 cm 100 .. 465 cm
6000 mm 600 .. 999 mm 1 .. 999 mm Plate
Pin HLS 528-2
100 .. 800 cm 100 .. 740 cm 1 +UB
Round bar
2 D1 (switching output 1)
Ø 27 mm
Recording ranges
Plate
Operational scanning range 250 mm: Operational scanning range 6000 mm:
Plate Plate
146
Model code: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
HLS 5 2 8 - X - XXXX - 000 - F the operating conditions and applications 7
Mechanical connection described.
2 = M30x1.5 For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Electrical connection Subject to technical modifications.
8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole
(connector not supplied)
Output
2 = 2 switching outputs
3 = 1 switching output and 1 analogue output
5 = 2 switching outputs and 1 analogue output
Operational scanning range in mm
0250; 0350; 1300, 3400, 6000
Modification number
000 = Standard
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
Dimensions:
Operational scanning range:
250 mm 350 mm,1300mm
Buttons
Buttons
Buttons Buttons
147
Electronic level sensors
In industry, level sensors are used for the most diverse tasks. In the main,
sensors which are based on capacitive, magnetostrictive or ultrasonic
measurement are used.
HYDAC ELECTRONIC has level sensors for each of these measurement
principles in its product range.
Page
HNT 1000 (magnetostrictive) 161
E 180.000.2 /11.13
148
Electronic
Level Switch
ENS 3000 8
149
Setting options: Additional functions: Pin connections:
All settings available on the ENS 3000 are Switching mode of the switching outputs
combined in 2 easy-to-navigate menus. adjustable (switching point function or
To prevent unauthorised adjustment of the window function) M12x1, 4 pole
instrument, a programming lock can be Switching direction of the switching
set. outputs adjustable (N/C or N/O function)
Switching outputs can be assigned to
Setting ranges of the fluid level or temperature, as required
switching points and Switch-on and switch-off delay
switch-back hystereses: adjustable from 0.00 .. 9999
8 seconds
Fluid level switching point function Display can be adjusted (actual fluid
Probe Meas. Switching Hysteresis level, actual temperature, peak values,
length range point switching point 1, 2, 3, 4 or display Pin ENS ENS
in cm in cm in cm * in cm * off)
3X16-2 3X16-3
25.0 17.0 0.3 .. 17.0 0.1 .. 16.8 Analogue output can be assigned to
fluid level or temperature as required 1 +UB +UB
41.0 29.0 0.5 .. 29.0 0.2 .. 28.7 (depending on model)
2 SP 2 Analogue
52.0 39.0 0.6 .. 39.0 0.2 .. 38.6
3 0V 0V
73.0 59.0 0.9 .. 59.0 0.3 .. 58.4
The increment for all units is 0.1 cm. 4 SP 1 SP 1
150
Model code: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
ENS 3 X 1 X – X – XXXX – 000 – K the operating conditions and applications
described.
Temperature sensor For applications or operating conditions
1 = With temperature sensor not described, please contact the relevant
2 = Without temperature sensor technical department.
Mechanical connection Subject to technical modifications.
1 = 22 mm collar
to fit cutting ring coupling G22L
Electrical connection 8
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
only possible on output models "2" and "3"
8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole
only possible on output model "5"
P = Male M12x1, 8 pole
only possible on output model "8"
Output
2 = 2 switching outputs
only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
3 = 1 switching output and 1 analogue output
only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
5 = 2 switching outputs and 1 analogue output
only in conjunction with electrical connection type "8"
8 = 4 switching outputs and 2 analogue outputs
only in conjunction with electrical connection type "P"
Probe length (physical) in mm
0250; 0410; 0520; 0730
Modification number
000 = Standard
Probe material
K = Ceramic
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or
the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, splash guards, etc. can be
found in the Accessories brochure.
Dimensions:
Rear view
dimension of contact M3 (earth screw M3
M12x1
Installation
and lock washer M3 supplied)
dimension
∅ 54
hex. SW27
Ø 29
Total length
Measuring range (upper end) Ø 25.1
Installation
dimension
Inactive zone
Ø 22 -0.2 ∅ 54
Probe length
∅ 54
(lower end)
151
8
152
E 18.061.4/11.13
Electronic
Level Switch
ENS 3000 8
153
Setting options: IO-Link-specific data:
All terms and symbols used for setting the Baud rate 38.4 kBaud *
ENS 3000 as well as the menu structure Cycle time 2.5 ms
comply with the specifications in the Process data width 16 Bit
VDMA Standard for level switches. Frame type 2.2
Specification V1.1
Setting ranges for the switch *C
onnection with unshielded standard sensor line possible
outputs: up to a max. line length of 20 m.
Download the IO Device Description (IODD) from:
Measuring Lower Upper limit of http://www.hydac.com/de-en/service/downloads-software-on-request/
8 range/ limit of SP / FH
probe length RP / FL
in cm in cm in cm Model code:
17.0 / 25.0 0.2 / 0.3 17.0 / 16.8 ENS 3 X 1 6 – L – XXXX – 000 –K
29.0 / 41.0 0.3 / 0.5 29.0 / 28.7
39.0 / 52.0 0.4 / 0.6 39.0 / 38.6 Temperature sensor
59.0 / 73.0 0.6 / 0.9 59.0 / 58.4 1 = With temperature sensor
2 = Without temperature sensor
Measuring Min. difference Increment*
Mechanical connection
range betw. RP & SP 1 = Collar Ø 22
and FL & FH Electrical connection
in cm in cm in cm 6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
17.0 / 25.0 0.1 / 0.1 0.1 (connector not supplied)
29.0 / 41.0 0.2 / 0.2 0.1 Output
39.0 / 52.0 0.2 / 0.3 0.1 L = IO-Link interface
59.0 / 73.0 0.3 / 0.5 0.1
Probe length, physical
* All ranges given in the table 0250; 0410; 0520; 0730 mm
are adjustable by the increments Modification number
shown. 000 = Standard
SP = switch point
RP = switch-back point Probe material
FL = level window lower value K = Ceramic
FH = level window upper value Notes:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
Additional functions: technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Switching mode of the switching outputs Accessories:
adjustable (switching point function or Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, mechanical connection
window function) adaptors, splash guards, etc. can be found in the Accessories brochure.
Switching direction of the switching
outputs adjustable (N/C or N/O function)
Switching outputs can be assigned to the Dimensions:
fluid level or temperature
Switch-on and switch-off delay M12x1 Rear view
Dimension of contact M3 (earth
Ø 42
adjustable from 0.00 .. 99.99 seconds installation
dimension
screw M3 and lock washer
(depending on version)
Ø 29
Ø 25.1
M12x1, 4 pole
Inactive zone
Ø 22 -0.2
(upper end)
L+
IO-Link
1 C/Q
2 4
Probe length
3
Inactive zone approx. approx. approx. approx.
L- (lower end) 22 28 34 50
Standard IO
Measuring
I/Q 170 290 390 590
range
Probe length 250 410 520 730
Inactive zone
(lower end)
154
Electronic
Level Switch
HNS 3000 8
155
Pin connections: Model code:
M12x1, 4 pole HNS 3 X X X – X – XXXX – 000
Temperature sensor
1 = With temperature sensor
2 = Without temperature sensor
Mechanical connection
2 = G3/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
Electrical connection
8 6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
only for output models "2" and "3"
8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole
Pin HNS 3X26-2 HNS 3X26-3 possible only for output model "5"
P = Male M12x1, 8 pole
1 +UB +UB
only for output model "8"
2 SP 2 Analogue
Output
3 0V 0V 2 = 2 switching outputs
4 SP 1 SP 1 only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
3 = 1 switching output and 1 analogue output
only in conjunction with electrical connection type "6"
M12x1, 5 pole 5 = 2 switching outputs and 1 analogue output
only in conjunction with electrical connection code type "8"
8 = 4 switching outputs and 2 analogue outputs
4 3
only in conjunction with electrical connection type "P"
5 Probe length (physical) in mm
0250; 0280; 0370; 0410; 0520; 0730
1 2 Modification number
000 = Standard
Notes:
Special models on request.
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or
Pin HNS 3X28-5 the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
1 +UB Accessories:
2 Analogue Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, splash guards, etc. can be
3 0V found in the Accessories brochure.
4 SP 1
5 SP 2
Dimensions:
M12x1
M12x1, 8 pole
6 4
5
7 3 Ø 44
8
1 2
SW 32
16
38
G 3/4 A
100 %
Pin HNS 3X2P-8
1 +UB
2 SP 2
Probe length
3 0V
4 SP 1
5 SP 3 Immersion depth
6 SP 4 at density 1
7 Analogue level 0%
50
8 Analogue temperature
34
Ø 23.5
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
E 18.061.2.0/11.13
156
Electronic
Level Switch
HNS 526 8
provided.
surface
157
Setting options: Operational scanning range 480 mm: Additional functions:
All the terms and symbols used for Switching mode of the switching
setting the HNS 526 as well as the menu outputs adjustable (switching
structure comply with the specifications point function or window function)
of the German Engineering Federation Switching direction of the switching
Standard (VDMA 24574-4) for level Plate outputs adjustable
switches. (N/C or N/O function)
In order to prevent unauthorised Round bar Switch-on delay adjustable from
adjustment of the device, a key-lock can
Ø 27 mm
0 to 20 seconds
be set. Energy saving mode
8 Setting ranges of the
switching points Pin connections:
or switch-back points:
M12x4, 4 pole
Switching point function distance and
window function distance
Oper. SP1, SP2, RP1, RP2,
scanning FH1, FH2 * FL1, FL2*
range
280 mm 2 .. 32 cm 1 .. 31 cm Operational scanning range 1600 mm:
2 .. 13 inch 1 .. 12 inch
480 mm 2 .. 59 cm 1 .. 58 cm
2 .. 23 inch 1 .. 22 inch
1600 mm 2 .. 180 cm 1 .. 179 cm
2 .. 71 inch 1 .. 70 inch Pin HNS 526-2 HNS 526-3
Plate
Window function.
FH1, FH2 = upper switch values 1 or 2
FL1, FL2 = lower switch values 1 or 2
* The increment for all devices is 1 cm or
1 inch.
Operational scanning range 4000 mm:
Plate
Round bar
Ø 27 mm
Recording ranges
(for different objects):
The grey areas show the detection range
for a very large reflector, e.g. a fluid
surface, providing the sensor is ideally
positioned. Outside the grey area, it is
not possible to evaluate the ultrasonic
reflections.
Operational scanning range 280 mm: Operational scanning range 6400 mm:
Plate Plate
Round bar
Round bar
Ø 11 mm
Ø 27 mm
E 18.604.0/11.13
158
Model code: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
HNS 5 2 6 - X - XXXX - 000 - F the operating conditions and applications
Mechanical connection described.
2 = M30x1.5 For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Electrical connection
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole Subject to technical modifications.
(connector not supplied)
8
Output
2 = 2 switching outputs
3 = 1 switching output and 1 analogue output
Operational scanning range in mm
0280; 0480; 1600, 4000, 6400
Modification number
000 = Standard
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
Dimensions:
Operational scanning range:
280 mm 480 mm,1600 mm
Buttons
Buttons
51
84
Buttons Buttons
159
8
160
E 18.604.0/11.13
Electronic
Level Transmitter
HNT 1000 8
161
Pin connections: Model code:
M12x1, 4 pole HNT 1 2 2 X – X – XXXX – 000
Temperature sensor
2 = Without temperature sensor
Mechanical connection
2 = G 3/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
Electrical connection
1 = Flying lead, 2 m
8 6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole
Output
Pin HNT 1226 B = 0 .. 10 V, 3 conductor
1 +UB C = 4 .. 20 mA, 3 conductor
2 n.c. Probe length (physical) in mm
3 0V 0250; 0280; 0370; 0410; 0520; 0730
4 Signal Modification number
000 = Standard
Notes:
M12x1, 5 pole Special models on request.
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
4 3 Accessories:
5 Appropriate accessories, such as electrical female connectors, can be found
in the Accessories section of the Electronics brochure.
1 2
Dimensions:
Ø 44
Pin HNT 1228 Male connector
M12x1, 4 pole M12x1
Ø 44
1 +UB
2 n.c. SW 32 SW 32
3 0V
4 Signal
16
16
5 n.c.
38
38
G 3/4 A G 3/4 A
100 % 100 %
Cable outlet
Probe length
Probe length
0% 0%
50
50
34
34
Ø 23.5
Core HNT 1221 Ø 23.5
brown +UB
white 0V
green Signal
yellow n.c.
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
E 18.604.1.0/11.13
162
E 18.604.1.0/11.13
8
163
FLOw RATE TRANSMITTERS
FLOw SwITCHES
To measure the flow rate in machines and systems HYDAC ELECTRONIC
offers various flow rate transmitters and flow switches.
The flow rate transmitter of the EVS 3000 series operates according to
the turbine principle (measuring the rpm of an impeller rotating in the fluid
flow). Depending on the model, additional connection ports are available for
pressure and/or temperature transmitters.
The HYDAC flow switches and transmitters in the HFS 2000 and
HFT 2000 series are based on the variable area float principle. The
test medium deflects a spring-loaded float in the direction of the flow,
depending on the flow rate. A reed contact is attached to the outside of the
instrument. When the magnet inside the float reaches the preset position,
the reed contact will switch.
9
Electronic flow rate transmitters for general
applications:
Page
EVS 3110 165
EVS 3100 167
Page
HFS 2100 169
HFS 2500 173
HFT 2100 177
HFT 2500 181
Further flow rate transmitters for special applications can be found in the
section "Service Instruments".
Flow rate
EVS 3100
HFS 2100
HFS 2500
EVS 3110
HFT 2100
HFT 2500
sensors,
flow
switches
Analogue output ü ü ü ü
Display ü ü
E 180.000.2 /11.13
164
Electronic
Flow Rate Transmitter
EVS 3110
for Water-Based Fluids
165
Model code: Pin connections:
EVS 3 1 1 X – A – XXXX – 000
Binder series 714 M18
Housing material
1 = Stainless steel
Electrical connection
4 = Male 4 pole Binder series 714 M18
(connector not supplied)
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
(connector not supplied)
Signal
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor Pin EVS 3114-A
1 reserved
Measuring range
0020 = 1.2 .. 20 l/min 2 Signal +
9 0060 = 6.0 .. 60 l/min 3 Signal -
0300 = 15.0 .. 300 l/min
0600 = 40.0 .. 600 l/min 4 reserved
Modification number
M12x1
000 = Standard
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
Pin EVS 3116-A
1 Signal +
2 reserved
3 Signal -
4 reserved
Dimensions:
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
Model Meas. L H D / SW G Torque DN
range value not described, please contact the relevant
[l/min] [mm] [mm] [mm] [Nm] [mm] technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
EVS 311X-A-0020 1.2 .. 20 117 135 47 / 46 G¼" 60 7
E 18.313.3/11.13
166
Electronic
Flow Rate Transmitter
EVS 3100
for Oils / Viscous Fluids
167
Model code: Pin connections:
EVS 3 1 0 X – A – XXXX – 000
Binder series 714 M18
Housing material
0 = Aluminium
Electrical connection
4 = Male 4 pole Binder series 714 M18
(connector not supplied)
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
(connector not supplied)
Signal
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor Pin EVS 3104-A
1 reserved
Measuring range
0020 = 1.2 .. 20 l/min 2 Signal +
9 0060 = 6.0 .. 60 l/min 3 Signal -
0300 = 15.0 .. 300 l/min
0600 = 40.0 .. 600 l/min 4 reserved
Modification number
M12x1
000 = Standard
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
Pin EVS 3106-A
1 Signal +
2 reserved
3 Signal -
4 reserved
Dimensions:
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
Model Meas. L H D / SW G Torque DN
range value not described, please contact the relevant
[l/min] [mm] [mm] [mm] [Nm] [mm] technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
EVS 310X-A-0020 1.2 .. 20 117 135 47 / 46 G¼" 60 7
E 18.331.2/11.13
168
Electro-mechanical
Flow Switch
HFS 2100
for Oils / Viscous Fluids
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
E 18.379.1/11.13
170
Dimensions without indicator:
G
OIL -Size 1- without indicator
Type Installation dimensions Weight
(approx.)
[l/min] [mm] [g]
DN SW G L
8 24 1/4“ 98 400
L
0.5 .. 1.6 10 24 3/8“ 108 450
15 27 1/2“ *) 90 350
0.8 .. 3.0
15 27 1/2“ 90 350
2.0 .. 7.0
*)
Standard
G 9
SW
OIL -Size 2- without indicator
Type Installation Weight
dimensions (approx.)
[l/min] [mm] [g]
DN SW G L T
171
Dimensions with indicator:
L
0.5 .. 1.6
0.8 .. 3.0 15 30 1/2“ 90 570
2.0 .. 7.0
Note:
E 18.379.1/11.13
172
Electro-Mechanical
Flow Switch
HFS 2500
for Water or Water-Based Media
3) Minimum load 3 VA
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65
Other data
Housing material Brass (nickel-plated) or stainless steel 1.4571
Electrical connection Male connection EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
Male connection M12x1
173
Model code: Pin connections:
HFS 2 5 X X – XX – XXXX–XXXX – X – X – X – 000
Measuring principle EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
2 = Variable area float
Test medium
5 = Water or
water-based
Mechanical
connection 4)5)
1 = 1/4 "
2 = 3/8 "
3 = 1/2 "
4 = 3/4 " Pin HFS 25X5-XS HFS 25X5-XW
5 = 1 "
6 = 1 1/4 " 1 Centre Centre
7 = 1 1/2 " 2 N/O contact N/C contact
9 Electrical connection
3 n.c. N/O contact
5 = Male EN175301-803
(DIN 43650) ┴ Housing Housing
3 pole + PE
(connector supplied)
6 = Male M12x1, 4-pole M12x1
(connector not supplied)
Switching contacts 6)
1S = 1 N/O contact
2S = 2 N/O contacts
1W = 1 Change-over contact
2W = 2 Change-over contacts
Switching ranges in l/min 5)
Water 5 %
00.2-04.0; 00.6-05.0; 00.5-08.0;
01.0-0014; 01.0-0028; 02.0-0040; 04.0-0055;
01.0-0070; 08.0-0090; 0005-0110; 0010-0150; Pin HFS 25X6-XS HFS 25X6-XW
0035-0220; 0035-0250; 1 Centre Centre
==================================== 2 n.c. N/C contact
Water 10 % - Size 1 - (only available without mech. indicator)
3 n.c. n.c.
.005-0.06; 0.04-0.13; 00.1-00.6; 00.2-01.2;
00.4-02.0; 00.5-03.0; 01.0-05.0 4 N/O contact N/O contact
Water 10 % - Size 2 -
0.02-00.2; 00.2-00.6; 00.4-01.8; 00.8-03.2;
02.0-07.0; 03.0-0013; 04.0-0020; 08.0-0030
Notes on installation:
Water 10 % - Size 3 -
The medium must not contain solid
0010-0030; 0015-0045; 0020-0060; particles! We recommend using
0030-0090; 0060-0150 contamination strainers.
Accuracy
6 = ≤ ± 5.0 % FS External magnetic fields can affect
7 = ≤ ± 10.0 % FS the switching contact.
Housing material Ensure sufficient distance from
B = Brass (nickel-plated) magnetic fields (e.g. from electric
S = Stainless steel motors)!
Mechanical indicator
0 = Without indicator
1 = With indicator
Modification number
000 = Standard
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
E 18.384.1/11.13
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
174
Dimensions without indicator:
Water 5 % Accuracy
0.2 .. 4.0
0.6 .. 5.0 1/4“ 8
3/8“ 10
0.5 .. 8.0 27 30 86 14 130 850
1/2“ 15
1 .. 14
1 .. 28
2 .. 40 1/2“ 15 14 148 9
27 30 86 900
4 .. 55 3/4“ 20 16 174
1 .. 70
34 40 96 3/4“ 20 18 152 1400
8 .. 90
40 40 96 1“ 25 19 156 1100
5 .. 110
10 .. 150 50 50 101 1 1/4“ 32 21 200 2750
35 .. 220 50 50 106 1 1/4“ 32 21 200 3000
35 .. 250 60 50 107 1 1/2“ 40 24 200 3800
*)
Standard
175
Dimensions with indicator:
G
Type Installation dimensions Weight
T
(approx.)
[l/min] [mm] [g]
SW D B G DN T L
L
Water 5 % Accuracy
0.2 .. 4.0 T
9 2 .. 40 1/2“ 15 14 148
27 30 86 990
4 .. 55 3/4“ 20 16 174
D +17
1 .. 70
34 40 96 3/4“ 20 18 152 1490
8 .. 90
40 40 96 1“ 25 19 156 1190
5 .. 110
10 .. 150 50 50 101 1 1/4“ 32 21 200 2840
35 .. 220 50 50 106 1 1/4“ 32 21 200 3090
35 .. 250 60 50 107 1 1/2“ 40 24 200 3890
176
Electronic
Flow Transmitter
HFT 2100
for Oils / Viscous Fluids
177
Model code: Pin connections:
HFT 2 1 X 6 – X – XXXX–XXXX – 7 – X – 0 – 000
Measuring principle M12x1
2 = Variable area float
Measuring medium
1 = Oils / viscous fluids
Mechanical
connection 2) 3)
1 = 1/4 “
2 = 3/8 “
3 = 1/2 “
4 = 3/4 “
5 = 1 “ Pin HFT 21X6-C HFT 21X6-B
Electrical connection 1 +UB +UB
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole 2 reserved reserved
(connector not supplied)
9 3 GND GND
Output signal
B = 0 .. 10 V, 3 conductor 4 4 .. 20 mA 0 .. 10 V
C = 4 .. 20 mA, 3 conductor
Measuring ranges in l/min 3)
Oil 10 % - Size 1 -
00.5-01.6; 00.8-03.0; 02.0-07.0 Notes on installation:
Oil 10 % -Size 2- The medium must not contain solid
00.5-01.5; 0001-0004; 0002-0008; 0003-0010; particles! We recommend using
0005-0015; 0008-0024; 0010-0030; 0015-0045; contamination strainers.
0020-0060; 0030-0090; 0035-0110
External magnetic fields can
Accuracy affect the switching contact.
7 = ≤ ± 10.0 % FS Ensure sufficient distance from
Housing material magnetic fields (e.g. from electric
B = Brass, nickel-plated motors)!
S = Stainless steel
Mechanical indicator
0 = Without indicator
Modification number
000 = Standard
Note:
Special models on request.
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
E 18.395.1/11.13
178
Dimensions:
Size 1 G
Type Installation Weight
dimensions (approx.)
[l/min] [mm] [g]
DN SW G L
8 24 1/4“ 98 610
L
0.5 .. 1.6 10 24 3/8“ 119 660
15 30 1/2“ *) 90 560
0.8 .. 3.0
15 30 1/2“ 90 560
2.0 .. 7.0 G
*)
Standard
SW 9
SW
Size 2 G
L
0.5 .. 1.5 8 34 1/4“ 152 10 1510
15 34 1/2“ 152 14 1435
1 .. 4 20 34 3/4“ 152 15 1350
25 40 1“ *) 130 17 1170 T
2 .. 8
G
3 .. 10 15 34 1/2“ 152 14 1435
20 34 3/4“ 152 15 1350
5 .. 15 25 40 1“ *) 130 17 1170 SW
8 .. 24
10 .. 30
SW
Note:
HYDAC electronic GmbH
The information in this brochure relates to the operating conditions and
E 18.395.1/11.13
179
9
180
E 18.395.1/11.13
Electronic
Flow Transmitter
HFT 2500
for water / water-based media
181
Model code: Pin connections:
HFT 2 5 X 6 – X – XXXX–XXXX – 5 – X – 0 – 000
Measuring principle M12x1
2 = Variable area float
Test medium
5 = Water /
water-based
Mechanical
connection 2)
1 = 1/4 “
2 = 3/8 “
3 = 1/2 “
4 = 3/4 “ Pin HFT 25X6-C HFT 25X6-B
5 = 1 “
6 = 1 1/4 “ 1 +UB +UB
7 = 1 1/2 “ 2 reserved reserved
9 Electrical connection
3 GND GND
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
(connector not supplied) 4 4 ..20 mA 0 ..10 V
Output signal
B = 0 .. 10 V, 3 conductor
C = 4 .. 20 mA, 3 conductor
Measuring ranges in l/min Notes on installation:
Size 1 The medium must not contain
.005-0.06; 0.04-0.13; 00.1-00.6; 00.2-01.2; 00.4-02.0; solid particles! We recommend
00.5-03.0; 01.0-05.0 using contamination strainers.
Size 2
External magnetic fields can affect the
0.02-00.2; 00.2-00.6; 00.4-01.8; 00.8-03.2; 02.0-07.0;
switching contact.
03.0-0013; 04.0-0020; 08.0-0030 Ensure sufficient distance from
Size 3 magnetic fields (e.g. from electric
0010-0030; 0015-0045; 0020-0060; 0030-0090; 0060-0150 motors)!
=============================================
Size 4
00.2-04.0; 00.6-05.0; 00.5-08.0; 01.0-0014; 01.0-0028;
02.0-0040; 04.0-0055;
01.0-0070; 08.0-0090; 0005-0110; 0010-0150;
0035-0220; 0035-0250
Accuracy
5 = ≤ ± 3.0 % FS
Housing material
B = Brass (nickel-plated)
S = Stainless steel
Mechanical indicator
0 = Without indicator
Modification number
000 = Standard
Note:
Special models on request.
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
E 18.601.0/11.13
182
Dimensions:
Size 1
SW G
0.005..0.06
T
0.04..0.13 □D
B
0.1..0.6
L
0.2..1.2 17 18 39 1/4“ 8 10 65 210
0.4..2.0 T
G
0.5..3.0
9
1.0..5.0
Size 2
SW G
0.02 .. 0.2
0.2 .. 0.6 T
□D
0.4 .. 1.8 B
0.8 .. 3.2
L
30 30 62 1/2 ’’ 15 14 90 560
2.0 .. 7.0
3.0 .. 13.0 T
4.0 .. 20.0 G
8.0 .. 30.0
Size 3
10 .. 30 SW G
G
Size 4
0.2 .. 4.0 SW
□D
G
0.6 .. 5.0 1/4“ 8
3/8“ 10 T
0.5 .. 8.0 27 40 52 14 131 900
1/2“ 15 B
1 .. 14
1 .. 28
L
2 .. 40 27 1/2“ 15 14 146
40 52 950
4 .. 55 32 3/4“ 20 16 174
1 .. 70
3/4“ T
34 40 62 20 18 152 1420
8 .. 90 1“ G
40 40 62 25 19 156 1120 SW
5 .. 110
10 .. 150 50 50 72 1 1/4“ 32 21 200 2770
35 .. 220 50 50 72 1 1/4“ 32 21 200 3020
35 .. 250 60 50 72 1 1/2“ 40 24 200 3820
*) Standard
E 18.601.0/11.13
183
speed sensors
The contact-free speed sensors of the HSS series detect the movement
of ferromagnetic structures, such as gear wheels, gear rims or perforated
discs, using the changes in magnetic flux.
10
E 180.000.2/11.13
184
Electronic
Speed Sensor
HSS 110
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage and short circuit protection (max. 50 mA)
are provided.
185
Pin connections: Model code:
Core HSS 110-1 HSS 110-4 HSS 1 1 0 – X – 018 – 000
red +UB +UB
black 0V PWM Signal type
1 = Output 1: Frequency
blue Frequency 4 = Output 1: Frequency and direction of rotation PWM
Probe length
Mounting position tolerance: 018 = 18.4 mm
Modification number
000 = Standard
Notes:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or
the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Dimensions:
(18.6) 6
3.7
±5°
10
ø10.2 -0.2
0
0
18.4 -0.25
ø 9.4 ±0.1
0
Ø 10.31 +0.025
0
M6
1.8
°
15
(9)
8
5.2
Ø 10.31
13 +0.2
0
13 +0.2
6.1 +0.2
0
0
R
7
7.1 ±0.2
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
E 18.606.0/11.13
186
Electronic
Speed Sensor
HSS 120
187
Pin connections: Model code:
Core HSS 120-2 HSS 1 2 0 – 2 – XXX – 000
brown +UB
blue Frequency 1 (A) Signal technology
2 = Outputs 1 and 2: Frequency (90° phase shift)
black 0V
Probe length
white Frequency 2 (B) 030 = 30 mm
035 = 35 mm
045 = 45 mm
Adjustment angle for other
Modification number
modules: 000 = Standard
It is possible to achieve a 90° phase shift
of the two frequency signals by turning the Notes:
sensor through the angle indicated in the On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or
table below. the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Dimensions:
-20° Module 1 Probe length (A): 35 mm, 45 mm
15
-15° Module 1.25
Ø
-10° Module 1.5 6.
4
± 0° Module 2 ± 0°
Ø 15.1
Ø 12
Ø 15
Module 2.5 +15°
.5
R 5
10 R
10
2.4
Specification for installation .5
cavity:
10
°+ M6
20
min. 1.5
min. 9
16.5
12
5
1.6*
Ø 15 HB FPM V80
R 0.4
35
9±0.25
.4
4.5±0.25
Probe length: 30 mm
1,000 +50
0 12
15±0.1
Ø 4.7±0.15
0
Ø12 -0.10
0
Ø15 -0.10
19.5
6
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
E 18.607.0/11.13
188
Electronic
Speed Sensor
HSS 130
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage and short circuit protection are
provided.
189
Pin connections: Model code:
Core HSS 130-2 HSS 130-3 HSS 1 3 0 – X – XXX – 000
brown +UB +UB
blue 0V 0V Signal technology
2 = Outputs 1 and 2: Frequency
black Frequency 1 Frequency (90° phase shift)
white Frequency 2 Direction of 3 = Output 1: Frequency
rotation Output 2: Direction of rotation
Probe length
Adjustment angle 016 = 16 mm
032 = 32 mm
for other modules:
Modification number
It is possible to achieve a 90° phase shift 000 = Standard
of the two frequency signals by turning the
sensor through the angle indicated in the Notes:
table below. On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or
the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Module 3 +17°
w
22
R15
v
24.5
0.1 A 0.2 A
20
.2 °
R0 45
8
A
R
°
90
2.4 +0.40
x
0
General tolerances for chipping
processes: ISO 2768-mH
Tolerance: ISO 8015
Surface quality: ISO 1302
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
E 18.608.0/11.13
190
Electronic
Speed Sensor
HSS 210
191
Pin connections: Model code:
M12x1, 4 pole HSS 2 1 0 – X – 050 – 000
Signal technology
2 = Outputs 1 and 2: Frequency
(90° phase shift)
3 = Output 1: Frequency
Output 2: Direction of rotation
Installation depth
050 = 50 mm max.
Modification number
000 = Standard
Pin HSS 210-2 HSS 210-3
Notes:
1 +UB +UB On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or
2 Frequency 1 (A) Frequency the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
3 0V 0V
4 Frequency 2 (B) Direction of
rotation Dimensions:
Adjustment angle
for other modules:
It is possible to achieve a 90° phase shift
M12x1
M12x1
Module 1
15 °
2 1 68
3 4
Key for
alignment
Module 1 +15°
Module 1.25 +18°
Module 1.5 +23°
Module 2 +30°
Module 2.5 +38°
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
E 18.609.0/11.13
192
Electronic
Speed Sensor
HSS 220
193
Pin connections: Model code:
M12x1, 4 pole HSS 2 2 0 – X – 046 – 000
Signal technology
2 = Outputs 1 and 2: Frequency
(90° phase shift)
3 = Output 1: Frequency
Output 2: Direction of rotation
Installation depth
046 = 46 mm max.
Modification number
000 = Standard
Pin HSS 220-2 HSS 220-3
Notes:
1 +UB +UB On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or
2 Frequency 2 Direction of the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
rotation
3 0V 0V
4 Frequency 1 Frequency Dimensions:
-12° Module 1
- 9° Module 1.25
- 7° Module 1.5
Ø 22
- 3° Module 1.75
70
Ø 16.8
M18x1
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
E 18.610.0/11.13
194
E 18.610.0/11.13
195
10
Electronic pressure transmitters
and linear position TRANSDUCERS for
applications with increased functional
safety
"Failsafe" is the keyword for vehicle designers of mobile machinery.
No single error is allowed to cause a breakdown or malfunction of part or
all of the system in safety-critical applications.
Page
HDA 4700 197
11
12
E 180.000.2/11.13
196
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4700
for Applications with Increased
Functional Safety
Functional Safety
PL d
PL d
Architecture Category 3
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and short circuit protection are provided
FS (Full Scale) = relative to the complete measuring range
1)
Other seal materials on request
2)
Other output signals on request
3)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
197
Model code: Pin connections:
HDA 4 7 4 X - C C - XXXX - XXXX - Pd- 000 M12x1
Mechanical connection
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
Electrical connection
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
(connector not supplied)
V = Male Deutsch DT04, 4 pole
(connector not supplied)
Pin HDA 4746-CC
Signal 1
C = 4 .. 20 mA, 3 conductor 1 +UB
2 Signal 2
Signal 2
C = 4 .. 20 mA, 3 conductor 3 0V
Dimensions:
output output
signal 1 signal 2
hex-SW27
hex-SW27
orifice Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.381.1/11.13
198
Linear Position Transducer
HLT 1100-R2
for Applications with Increased
Functional Safety
Functional Safety
PL d
SIL 2
are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to the full measuring range
199
Model code: Pin connections:
Mobile HLT 1 1 0 0 – R2 – XXX – XXX – XXXX – S2PD – 000 Cable outlet
Design/
Geometry type
1 = Rod
Mechanical connection
R2 = Cylinder-integrated
Electrical connection
Cable output Core Analogue CANopen
K01 = Flying lead, length 1 m
K02 = Flying lead, length 2 m brown +UB +UB
K05 = Flying lead, length 5 m white 0V 0V
K10 = Flying lead, length 10 m
green Analogue CAN_L
Separate panel mount connection M12x1 yellow n.c. CAN_H
(4 pole for signal output analogue
5 pole for signal output CANopen)
L06 = 60 mm cable length M12x1, 4 pole
L18 = 180 mm cable length
L24 = 240 mm cable length
Signal output
C01 = Analogue 4 .. 20 mA, 3 conductor
CAN = CANopen
Accessories: 1 2
Appropriate accessories, such as position magnets, etc. can be found in the
Accessories section of the Electronics brochure.
The recommended position magnet ZBL MR33, part no. 6084207, must be
ordered separately.
Pin Signal Description
1 n.c.
2 +UB supply+
Dimensions: 3 0V supply-
4 CAN_H bus line dominant high
5 CAN_L bus line dominant low
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
Damping zone Measuring length Zero position
E 18.372.1.0/11.13
200
E 18.372.1.0/11.13
201
11
Sensors for potentially explosive atmospheres
Sensors for Potentially Explosive Locations: For several years
Page HYDAC ELECTRONIC has been
HDA 4700 ATEX, CSA, IECEx Flameproof enclosure 203 systematically stepping up the
EDS 4400 ATEX, CSA, IECEx Flameproof enclosure, programmable 207 expansion of its range of sensors for
ETS 4500 ATEX, CSA, IECEx Flameproof enclosure 211 potentially explosive locations.
HDA 4700 ATEX Intrinsically safe 215 The sensors for potentially explosive
locations can be supplied with a variety
HDA 4400 ATEX Intrinsically safe 219
of output signals, connectors and fluid
HDA 4300 ATEX Intrinsically safe 223 port connection options.
HDA 4100 ATEX Intrinsically safe 227 This versatility, combined with
EDS 4400 ATEX Intrinsically safe, programmable 231 certification to ATEX, CSA and IECEx,
EDS 4300 ATEX Intrinsically safe, programmable 235 ensures worldwide acceptance
EDS 4100 ATEX Intrinsically safe, programmable 239 of our products.
HDA 4700 CSA Intrinsically Safe 243
HDA 4400 CSA Intrinsically Safe 247
HDA 4300 CSA Intrinsically Safe 251
HDA 4100 CSA Intrinsically Safe 255
HDA 4700 IECEx Intrinsically safe 259
HDA 4400 IECEx Intrinsically safe 263
HDA 4300 IECEx Intrinsically safe 267
HDA 4100 IECEx Intrinsically safe 271
HDA 4700 Flush membrane ATEX Intrinsically safe 275
HDA 4400 Flush membrane ATEX Intrinsically safe 279
HDA 4300 Flush membrane ATEX Intrinsically safe 283
HDA 4700 Flush membrane IECEx Intrinsically safe 287
HDA 4400 Flush membrane IECEx Intrinsically safe 291
HDA 4300 Flush membrane IECEx Intrinsically safe 295
HDA 4700 Flush membrane ATEX, CSA, IECEx flameproof enclosure 299
HFS 2100 ATEX Intrinsically safe 303
HFS 2500 ATEX Intrinsically safe 307
Further sensors for potentially explosive locations can be found in the section "OEM
Products for Large Volume Production" .
12
HDA 4700
HDA 4400
HDA 4300
HDA 4100
EDS 4400
EDS 4300
EDS 4100
HFS 2500
HFS 2100
ETS 4500
Sensors
for potentially
explosive atmospheres
Pressure ü ü ü ü ü ü ü
Temperature ü
Flow rate ü ü
Available as individual units ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü
OEM product for large volume production ü ü ü
Flush membrane ü ü ü
ATEX-Intrinsically safe ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü
Flush membrane ATEX-Intrinsically safe ü ü ü
CSA Intrinsically safe ü ü ü
IECEx Intrinsically safe ü ü ü ü
Flush membrane IECEx Intrinsically safe ü ü ü
ATEX, IECEx, CSA,
flameproof enclosure ü ü ü
E 180.000.2/11.13
202
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4700
ATEX, CSA, IECEx
Flameproof Enclosure
2)
Other mechanical connections on request
Very small temperature error 3)
Other output signals on request
4)
-20 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
Excellent EMC characteristics
Excellent durability
203
Pin connections: Areas of application:
Conduit (single cores) Approvals CCSAUS: Explosion Proof - Seal not required
ATEX: Flame Proof
IECEx: Flame Proof
Certificate ATEX KEMA 10ATEX100X
CSA MC 224264
IECEx KEM 10.0053X
Applications / CCSAUS:
Protection types Class I Group A, B, C, D, T6; T5
Class II Group E, F, G
Class III
Type 4
Core HDA 47X9-A
ATEX:
red Signal + I M2 Ex d I Mb
II 2G Ex d IIC T6, T5 Gb
black Signal -
II 2D Ex tb IIIC T110 .. 130 °C Db
green- Housing
yellow IECEx:
Ex d I Mb
Conduit (flying leads) Ex d IIC T6, T5 Gb
Ex tb IIIC T110 .. 130 °C Db
Model code:
HDA 4 7 X X – A – XXXX – D X – 000 (2m)
Mechanical connection
2 = G1/2 DIN 3852
(only for "1000 bar" press. range)
Core HDA 47XG-A 4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852
white Signal + Electrical connection
9 = 1/2-14 NPT Conduit (male thread),
brown Signal - single cores
green n.c. G = 1/2-14 NPT Conduit (male thread),
yellow n.c. flying leads
Signal
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
12
Pressure ranges in bar
0006; 0016; 0040; 0060; 0100; 0250; 0400; 0600
(only in conjunction with mechanical connection type "4")
1000
(only in conjunction with mechanical connection type "2")
Approval
D = CSA Explosion Proof - Seal not required
ATEX Flame Proof
IECEx Flame Proof
Type of measurement cell
S = Sealed Gauge (sealed to atmosphere) ≥ 40 bar
V = Vented Gauge (vented to atmosphere) ≤ 16 bar
Modification number
000 = Standard
Cable length in m
Standard = 2 m
Notes:
Special models on request. On instruments with a different modification number,
please read the label or the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found
in the Accessories brochure.
E 18.385.1/11.13
204
Dimensions:
Venting Venting
hex SW27
hex SW27
12
elastomer
profile
seal ring
Note:
E 18.385.1/11.13
205
12
206
E 18.385.1/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 4400 Programmable
ATEX, CSA, IECEx
Flameproof Enclosure
207
Setting ranges for the switch Areas of application:
outputs: Approvals CCSAUS: Explosion Proof - Seal not required
- Switch point or upper switch value ATEX: Flame Proof
5% .. 100% of the measurement range IECEx: Flame Proof
- Hysteresis or lower switch value Certificate ATEX KEMA 10ATEX100X
1% .. 96% of the measurement range CSA MC 224264
IECEx KEM 10.0053X
Pin connections: Applications / CCSAUS:
ATEX:
I M2 Ex d I Mb
II 2G Ex d IIC T6, T5 Gb
II 2D Ex tb IIIC T110 .. 130 °C Db
Core EDS 44x9-*-1P EDS 44x9-*-2P
red +UB +UB IECEx:
white Switch output 1 Switch output 1 Ex d I Mb
Ex d IIC T6, T5 Gb
brown --------- Switch output 2 Ex tb IIIC T110 .. 130 °C Db
black 0V 0V
green SDA1) SDA1)
Model code:
Conduit (flying leads)
EDS 4 4 X X – XXXX – X P – D X – 000 (2m)
Mechanical connection
2 = G1/2 DIN 3852
(only for "1000 bar" press. range)
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852
Electrical connection
9 = 1/2-14 NPT Conduit (male thread),
Core EDS 44xG-*-1P EDS 44xG-*-2P single cores
white Switch output 1 Switch output 1 G = 1/2-14 NPT Conduit (male thread),
flying leads
brown n.c. Switch output 2
Pressure ranges in bar
green SDA1) SDA1)
0006; 0016; 0040; 0060; 0100; 0250; 0400; 0600
12 yellow 0V 0V (only in conjunction with mech. connection type "4")
grey +UB +UB 1000
(only in conjunction with mech. connection type "2")
1) Programming line
Number of switch outputs
Programming Unit: 1 = 1 switch output
(must be ordered separately) 2 = 2 switch outputs
HPG 3000 – 000 Output type
Portable Programming Unit P = Programmable
Part. No. 909 422
Approval
D = CSA Explosion Proof - Seal not required
ATEX Flame Proof
IECEx Flame Proof
Type of measurement cell
S = Sealed Gauge (sealed to atmosphere) ≥ 40 bar
V = Vented Gauge (vented to atmosphere) ≤ 16 bar
Modification number
000 = Standard
Cable length in m
Standard = 2 m
Notes:
Special models on request.
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
electr. conn.
female 5 pole
CAUTION!
The HPG 3000 Programming Unit may
only be used outside the potentially
explosive area.
208
Dimensions:
Venting Venting
hex-SW27 hex-SW27
hex-SW27
hex-SW27
12
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869
Note:
E 18.386.1/11.13
209
12
210
E 18.386.1/11.13
Electronic
Temperature Transmitter
ETS 4500
ATEX, CSA, IECEx
Flameproof Enclosure
(depending on model)
Excellent EMC characteristics
Excellent durability
211
Pin connections: Areas of application:
Conduit (single cores) Approvals CCSAUS: Explosion Proof - Seal not required
ATEX: Flame Proof
IECEx: Flame Proof
Certificate ATEX KEMA 10ATEX100X
CSA MC 224264
IECEx KEM 10.0053X
Applications / CCSAUS:
Protection types Class I Group A, B, C, D, T6; T5
Class II Group E, F, G
Class III
Type 4
Core ETS 4549-A
ATEX:
red Signal + I M2 Ex d I Mb
II 2G Ex d IIC T6, T5 Gb
black Signal -
II 2D Ex tb IIIC T110 .. 130 °C Db
green- Housing
yellow IECEx:
Ex d I Mb
Conduit (flying leads) Ex d IIC T6, T5 Gb
Ex tb IIIC T110 .. 130 °C Db
Model code:
ETS 4 5 4 X – A– D – XXX – 000 (2m)
Mechanical connection
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852
Electrical connection
Core ETS 454G-A 9 = 1/2-14 NPT Conduit (male thread),
single cores
white Signal +
G = 1/2-14 NPT Conduit (male thread),
brown Signal - flying leads
green n.c. Signal
yellow n.c. A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
Approval
D = CSA Explosion Proof - Seal not required
12 ATEX Flame Proof
IECEx Flame Proof
Probe length
010 = 10.7 mm
100 = 100 mm
250 = 250 mm
350 = 350 mm
Modification number
000 = Standard
Cable length in m
Standard = 2 m
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical female connectors, can be found
in the Accessories brochure.
E 18.387.1/11.13
212
Dimensions:
hex-SW27
hex-SW27
hex-SW27 hex-SW27
12
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869
Note:
E 18.387.1/11.13
213
12
214
E 18.387.1/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4700
ATEX Intrinsically Safe
ATEX Dustproof Enclosure
ATEX Non-sparking
215
Areas of application:
Code No.for use
1 9 A C
in Model code
Protection type II 1D Ex ta lllC T80°C
II 1G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga II 3G Ex ic llC T6 Gc
T500T90°C Da
I M1 Ex ia I Ma II 1/2G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga/Gb II 2G Ex ia IIC T6 Gb II 3G Ex nA llC T6 Gc II 3D Ex ic lllC T80°C Dc
II 1D Ex ia lIIC T85°C Da
II 2D Ex tb lllC T80°C Db
Certificate KEMA 05ATEX1016 X / KEMA 05ATEX1021
Group I Group II, lll Group II Group II Group IIl Group II, lll
Category M1 Category 1G, 1/2G, 1D Category 2G Category 3G Category 1D, 2D Category 3G, 3D
Mining Gases/conductive dust Gases Gases Conductive dust Gases/conductive dust
Zones / Protection Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class:
Categories class: intrinsically safe ia intrinsically safe ia Non-sparking nA Dustproof enclosure Intrinsically safe ic
intrinsically with barrier with barrier with barrier
safe ia
with barrier
Electrical 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 6 6 4,5,6
Connection
(see model
code)
Devices in ignition protection class "Dustproof enclosure" for the protection types II 1D Ex ta lllC T80/90/100° C Da T500T90/T100/T110°C Da, II 2D Ex tb lllC T80/90/100°C Db
and ll 3D Ex tc lllC T80/90/100°C Dc are available with flying leads on request.
Devices in the ignition protection class "Non-sparking" for the protection type II 3G Ex nA llC T6, T5, T4 Gc are available with flying leads on request.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found
in the Accessories brochure.
Pin HDA 47X6-A
1 Signal +
E 18.335.2/11.13
2 n.c.
3 Signal -
4 n.c.
216
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
Protection types and applications (code): 1, C the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
12.3
12
Ø 35
59.4
Ø 27
hex. SW27
12
2+0,3
hex. SW27 12
elastomer
profile gasket
DIN 3869
optional
O-ring
20.35 x 1.78
Impact
protected metal
safety sleeve
SW25
hex. SW27
E 18.335.2/11.13
217
12
218
E 18.335.2/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4400
ATEX Intrinsically Safe
ATEX Dustproof Enclosure
ATEX Non-sparking
FS (Full Scale) = relative to the full measuring range, B.F.S.L.= Best Fit Straight Line
1)
1000 bar only with mechanical connection G 1/2 DIN 3852 and vice versa
2)
-20 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
3)
500 V AC on request
219
Areas of application:
Code No. for use
1 9 A C
in Model code
Protection type II 1D Ex ta lllC T80°C
II 1G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga II 3G Ex ic llC T6 Gc
T500T90°C Da
I M1 Ex ia I Ma II 1/2G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga/Gb II 2G Ex ia IIC T6 Gb II 3G Ex nA llC T6 Gc II 3D Ex ic lllC T80°C Dc
II 1D Ex ia lIIC T85°C Da
II 2D Ex tb lllC T80°C Db
Certificate KEMA 05ATEX1016 X / KEMA 05ATEX1021
Group I Group II, lll Group II Group II Group IIl Group II, lll
Category M1 Category 1G, 1/2G, 1D Category 2G Category 3G Category 1D, 2D Category 3G, 3D
Mining Gases/conductive dust Gases Gases Conductive dust Gases/conductive dust
Zones / Protection Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class:
Categories class: intrinsically safe ia intrinsically safe ia Non-sparking nA Dustproof enclosure Intrinsically safe ic
intrinsically with barrier with barrier with barrier
safe ia
with barrier
Electrical 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 6 6 4,5,6
Connection
(see model
code)
Devices in ignition protection class "Dustproof enclosure" for the protection types II 1D Ex ta lllC T80/90/100° C Da T500T90/T100/T110°C Da, II 2D Ex tb lllC T80/90/100°C Db
and ll 3D Ex tc lllC T80/90/100°C Dc are available with flying leads on request.
Devices in the ignition protection class "Non-sparking" for the protection type II 3G Ex nA llC T6, T5, T4 Gc are available with flying leads on request.
Pin connections:
Model code:
Binder series 714 M18
HDA 4 4 X X – A – XXXX – A N X – 000
Mechanical connection
2 = G1/2 DIN 3852
(only for "1000 bar" press. range)
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
Electrical connection
4 = Male 4 pole Binder series 714 M18
(connector not supplied)
Pin HDA 44X4-A 5 = Male 3 pole + PE, EN175301-803
(DIN 43650)
1 n.c. (connector supplied)
2 Signal + 6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole
(connector not supplied)
3 Signal -
Signal
12 4 n.c. A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
Pressure ranges in bar
EN175301-803 (DIN 43650) 0016; 0060; 0100; 0250; 0400; 0600
1000 (only in conjunction with mechanical connection code "2")
Approval
A = ATEX
Insulation voltage
N = 50 V AC
Protection type and applications (code)
1 = I M1 Ex ia I Ma
II 1G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga
Pin HDA 44X5-A II 1/2G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga/Gb
1 Signal + II 2G Ex ia IIC T6 Gb
II 1D Ex ia lIIC T85 °C Da
2 Signal - 9 = II 3G Ex nA llC T6 Gc (only in conjunction with electr. conn. “6“)*
3 n.c. A = II 1D Ex ta lllC T80 °C T500T90 °C Da (only in conjunction with electr. conn. "6")*
^ Housing II 2D Ex tb lllC T80 °C Db
C = II 3G Ex ic llC T6 Gc
ll 3D Ex ic lllC T80 °C Dc
M12x1
Modification number
000 = Standard
Notes:
* For design and electrical connection see device dimensions
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found
Pin HDA 44X6-A in the Accessories brochure.
1 Signal +
E 18.336.2/11.13
2 n.c.
3 Signal -
4 n.c.
220
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
Protection types and applications (code): 1, C the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
12.3
12
Ø 35
59.4
Ø 27
hex-SW27
12
2+0,3
hex-SW27
12
elastomer
profile gasket
DIN 3869
optional
O-ring
20.35 x 1.78
Impact
protected metal
safety sleeve
SW25
hex-SW27
E 18.336.2/11.13
221
12
222
E 18.336.2/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4300
ATEX Intrinsically Safe
ATEX Dustproof Enclosure
ATEX Non-sparking
Weight ~ 180 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage,
override and short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to the full measuring range, B.F.S.L.= Best Fit Straight Line
1)
-20 °C with FPM or EPDM seal, -40 °C on request
2)
500 V AC on request
223
Areas of application:
Code No.for use
1 9 A C
in Model code
Protection type II 1D Ex ta lllC T80°C
II 1G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga II 3G Ex ic llC T6 Gc
T500T90°C Da
I M1 Ex ia I Ma II 1/2G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga/Gb II 2G Ex ia IIC T6 Gb II 3G Ex nA llC T6 Gc II 3D Ex ic lllC T80°C Dc
II 1D Ex ia lIIC T85°C Da
II 2D Ex tb lllC T80°C Db
Certificate KEMA 05ATEX1016 X / KEMA 05ATEX1021
Group I Group II, lll Group II Group II Group IIl Group II, lll
Category M1 Category 1G, 1/2G, 1D Category 2G Category 3G Category 1D, 2D Category 3G, 3D
Mining Gases/conductive dust Gases Gases Conductive dust Gases/conductive dust
Zones / Protection Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class:
Categories class: intrinsically safe ia intrinsically safe ia Non-sparking nA Dustproof enclosure Intrinsically safe ic
intrinsically with barrier with barrier with barrier
safe ia
with barrier
Electrical 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 6 6 4,5,6
Connection
(see model
code)
Devices in ignition protection class "Dustproof enclosure" for the protection types II 1D Ex ta lllC T80/90/100 °C Da T500T90/T100/T110 °C Da, II 2D Ex tb lllC T80/90/100 °C Db
and ll 3D Ex tc lllC T80/90/100 °C Dc are available with flying leads on request.
Devices in the ignition protection class "Non-sparking" for the protection type II 3G Ex nA llC T6, T5, T4 Gc are available with flying leads on request.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors can be found
Pin HDA 4346-A in the Accessories brochure.
1 Signal +
E 18.337.2/11.13
2 n.c.
3 Signal -
4 n.c.
224
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
Protection types and applications (code): 1, C the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
12.3
12
Ø 35
59.4
Ø 27
hex. SW27
12
2+0,3
Impact
protected metal
safety sleeve
SW25
hex. SW27
The impact protected metal safety sleeve is included. A straight female connector is
required for electrical connection; e.g. female connector M12x1, 4 pole, straight, with
3m shielded cable: ZBE 06S-03, Part No. 6098243
E 18.337.2/11.13
225
12
226
E 18.337.2/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4100
ATEX Intrinsically Safe
ATEX Dustproof housing
ATEX Non-sparking
Weight ~ 180 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage,
override and short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to the full measuring range, B.F.S.L.= Best Fit Straight Line
1)
-20 °C with FPM or EPDM seal, -40 °C on request
2)
500 V AC on request
227
Areas of application:
Code No.for use
1 9 A C
in Model code
Protection type II 1D Ex ta lllC T80°C
II 1G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga II 3G Ex ic llC T6 Gc
T500T90°C Da
I M1 Ex ia I Ma II 1/2G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga/Gb II 2G Ex ia IIC T6 Gb II 3G Ex nA llC T6 Gc II 3D Ex ic lllC T80°C Dc
II 1D Ex ia lIIC T85°C Da
II 2D Ex tb lllC T80°C Db
Certificate KEMA 05ATEX1016 X / KEMA 05ATEX1021
Group I Group II, lll Group II Group II Group IIl Group II, lll
Category M1 Category 1G, 1/2G, 1D Category 2G Category 3G Category 1D, 2D Category 3G, 3D
Mining Gases/conductive dust Gases Gases Conductive dust Gases/conductive dust
Zones / Protection Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class:
Categories class: intrinsically safe ia intrinsically safe ia Non-sparking nA Dustproof enclosure Intrinsically safe ic
intrinsically with barrier with barrier with barrier
safe ia
with barrier
Electrical 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 6 6 4,5,6
Connection
(see model
code)
Devices in ignition protection class "Dustproof enclosure" for the protection types II 1D Ex ta lllC T80/90/100° C Da T500T90/T100/T110°C Da, II 2D Ex tb lllC T80/90/100°C Db
and ll 3D Ex tc lllC T80/90/100°C Dc are available with flying leads on request.
Devices in the ignition protection class "Non-sparking" for the protection type II 3G Ex nA llC T6, T5, T4 Gc are available with flying leads on request.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors can be found
Pin HDA 4146-A in the Accessories brochure.
1 Signal +
E 18.338.2/11.13
2 n.c.
3 Signal -
4 n.c.
228
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
Protection types and applications (code): 1, C the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
12.3
12
Ø 35
59.4
Ø 27
hex. SW27
12
2+0,3
Impact
protected metal
safety sleeve
SW25
hex. SW27
The impact protected metal safety sleeve is included. A straight female connector is
required for electrical connection; e.g. female connector M12x1, 4 pole, straight, with
3m shielded cable: ZBE 06S-03, Part. No. 6098243
E 18.338.2/11.13
229
12
230
E 18.338.2/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 4400 Programmable
ATEX Intrinsically Safe
Switch-on
Instruments for other Protection types and applications are available on request.
delay 8 2040 Please contact our technical sales department for more information.
Ton1/Ton2
Switch-off Model code:
delay
ToF1/ToF2
8 2040
EDS 4 4 4 8 – XXXX – P – A N X – 000
The increment for all instruments is 8 ms. Mechanical connection
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
Pin connections: Electrical connection
8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole
M12x1, 5 pole (connector not supplied)
12 Pressure ranges in bar
4 3 0060; 0100; 0250; 0400; 0600
5 Switching output
P = Programmable
1 2
Approval
A = ATEX
Insulation voltage
N = 50 V AC
Pin Process HPG Protection types and applications (code)
connection connection 1 = I M1 Ex ia I
2 = II 1G Ex ia IIC T4, T5, T6
1 +UB +UB 3 = II 2G Ex ia IIC T4, T5, T6 / II 1/2G Ex ia IIC T4, T5, T6
2 0V Comport 1 * 8 = II 1D Ex iaD 20 T100 °C
3 0V 0V Modification number
000 = Standard
4 Out 1 n.c.
5 0V Comport 2 *
* Comport = programming connection Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found
in the Accessories brochure.
E 18.339.2/11.13
232
Safety instructions: Note:
These units must only be programmed outside the potentially explosive location. The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
When operating in potentially explosive locations, the programming cables
applications described.
may only be connected to the 0 V outside of the potentially explosive area. For applications or operating conditions
The switching output draws the switching energy from the power supply to the not described, please contact the relevant
pressure switch. No additional energy is introduced into the electrical circuit technical department.
through the switching output. Subject to technical modifications.
The dual Zener barriers specified and approved in the technical data must be
used to connect the pressure switch.
These have a reverse polarity diode to decouple the signal.
The signal path may only be passively loaded.
Ensure that measured fluids in contact with the pressure switch are compatible
with the materials used.
Dimensions:
hex-SW27
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869 12
Programming Unit:
(must be ordered separately)
HPG 3000 – 000
Portable Programming Unit
Part. No. 909 422
electr. conn.
E 18.339.2/11.13
233
12
234
E 18.339.2/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 4300 Programmable
ATEX Intrinsically Safe
Minimum Maximum
Instruments for other Protection types and applications are available on request.
value in ms value in ms Please contact our technical sales department for more information.
Switch-on
delay 8 2040 Model code:
Ton1/Ton2 EDS 4 3 4 8 – XXXX – P – A N X – 000 – X 1
Switch-off
delay 8 2040 Mechanical connection
ToF1/ToF2 4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
The increment for all instruments is 8 ms. Electrical connection
8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole
Pin connections: (connector not supplied)
12 Pressure ranges in bar
M12x1, 5 pole
01.0; 02.5; 04.0; 06.0; 0010; 0016; 0025; 0040
Switching output
4
5
3 P = Programmable
Approval
1 2 A = ATEX
Insulation voltage
N = 50 V AC
Protection types and applications (code)
Pin Process HPG 1 = I M1 Ex ia I
connection connection
2 = II 1G Ex ia IIC T4, T5, T6
1 +UB +UB 3 = II 2G Ex ia IIC T4, T5, T6 / II 1/2G Ex ia IIC T4, T5, T6
2 0V Comport 1 * 8 = II 1D Ex iaD 20 T100 °C
3 0V 0V Modification number
000 = Standard
4 Out 1 n.c.
Seal material (in contact with fluid)
5 0V Comport 2 * F = FPM seal (e.g.: for hydraulic oils)
* Comport = programming connection E = EPDM seal (e.g.: for refrigerants)
Material of connection (in contact with fluid)
1 = Stainless steel
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found
in the Accessories brochure.
E 18.340.1/11.13
236
Safety instructions: Note:
These units must only be programmed outside the potentially explosive location. The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
When operating in potentially explosive locations, the programming cables may
applications described.
only be connected to the 0 V outside of the potentially explosive area. For applications or operating conditions
The switching output draws the switching energy from the power supply to the not described, please contact the relevant
pressure switch. No additional energy is introduced into the electrical circuit technical department.
through the switching output. Subject to technical modifications.
Dual Zener barriers specified and approved in the technical data must be used to
connect the pressure switch.
These have a reverse polarity diode to decouple the signal.
The signal path may only be passively loaded.
Ensure that measured fluids in contact with the pressure switch are compatible
with the materials used.
Dimensions:
hex-SW27
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869 12
Programming Unit:
(must be ordered separately)
HPG 3000 – 000
Portable Programming Unit
Part. No. 909 422
electr. conn.
E 18.340.1/11.13
237
12
238
E 18.340.1/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 4100 Programmable
ATEX Intrinsically Safe
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found
in the Accessories brochure.
E 18.341.2/11.13
240
Safety instructions: Note:
These units must only be programmed outside the potentially explosive location. The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
When operating in potentially explosive locations, the programming cables may
applications described.
only be connected to the 0 V outside of the potentially explosive area. For applications or operating conditions
The switching output draws the switching energy from the power supply to the not described, please contact the relevant
pressure switch. No additional energy is introduced into the electrical circuit technical department.
through the switching output. Subject to technical modifications.
Dual Zener barriers specified and approved in the technical data must be used to
connect the pressure switch.
These have a reverse polarity diode to decouple the signal.
The signal path may only be passively loaded.
Ensure that measured fluids in contact with the pressure switch are compatible
with the materials used.
Dimensions:
hex-SW27
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869 12
Programming Unit:
(must be ordered separately)
HPG 3000 – 000
Portable Programming Unit
Part. No. 909 422
electr. conn.
E 18.341.2/11.13
241
12
242
E 18.341.2/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4700
CSA Intrinsically safe
CSA Non Incendive
Electrical 9, A 5, 9, A 5, 9, A 9
Connection
Code for A B C
Model Code
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors can be found
in the Accessories brochure.
E 18.342.2/11.13
244
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
welded
hex.-SW27
12
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869
hex.-SW27
elastomer
profile gasket
DIN 3869
optional
O-ring
20.35 x 1.78
E 18.342.2/11.13
245
12
246
E 18.342.2/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4400
CSA Intrinsically safe
CSA Non Incendive
Weight ~ 150 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override
and short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range, B.F.S.L.= Best Fit Straight Line
1)
1000 bar only with mechanical connection G ½ DIN 3852 and vice versa
2)
Other seal materials available on request
3)
-20 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
4)
500 V AC on request
247
Pin connections: Areas of application:
Conduit (single cores) Group 1 2 3 4
Protection Intrinsically safe Intrinsically safe Non incendive Non incendive
Type (with field cabling)
Gases and dusts Gases Gases Gases and dusts
Certificate CSA 1760344
Intrinsically safe Intrinsically safe Non incendive Non incendive
Electrical 9, A 5, 9, A 5, 9, A 9
Connection
Code for A B C
Model Code
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors can be found
in the Accessories brochure.
E 18.342.1.0/11.13
248
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
welded
hex.-SW27
12
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869
hex.-SW27
elastomer
profile gasket
DIN 3869
optional
O-ring
20.35 x 1.78
E 18.342.1.0/11.13
249
12
250
E 18.342.1.0/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4300
CSA Intrinsically safe
CSA Non Incendive
Weight ~ 180 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and
short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
B.F.S.L.= Best Fit Straight Line
1)
psi pressure ranges on request
2)
-20 °C with FPM or EPDM seal, -40° on request
3)
500 V AC on request 251
Pin connections: Areas of application:
Conduit (single cores) Group 1 2 3 4
Protection Intrinsically safe Intrinsically safe Non incendive Non incendive
Type (with field cabling)
Gases and dusts Gases Gases Gases and dusts
Certificate CSA 1760344
Intrinsically safe Intrinsically safe Non incendive Non incendive
Electrical 9, A 5, 9, A 5, 9, A 9
Connection
Code for A B C
Model Code
Model code:
HDA 4 3 4 X – A – XXXX – C N X – 000 – X 1 (2m)
Pin HDA 43X5-A HDA 43XA-A
Mechanical connection
1 Signal + Signal + 4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
2 Signal - Signal - Electrical connection
5 = Male, 3 pole+ PE, EN175301-803
3 n.c. n.c. (DIN 43650)
^ Housing Housing (connector supplied)
9 = Conduit connection thread
12 (1/2-14 NPT, male)
A = Male, EN175301-803
(DIN 43650), 3 pole + PE
(1/2’’ conduit female thread)
Signal
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
Pressure ranges in bar
0001(-1..1); 01.0; 02.5; 04.0; 06.0; 0010; 0016; 0025; 0040
Approval
C = CSA
Insulation voltage
N = 50 V AC
Protection types and applications (code)
A = Group 1
B = Group 2 and 3
C = Group 4
Modification number
000 = Standard
Seal material (in contact with fluid)
F = FPM seal (e.g.: for hydraulic oils)
E = EPDM seal (e.g.: for refrigerants)
Material of connection (in contact with fluid)
1 = Stainless steel
Cable length in m (only for electr. connection type 9)
Standard = 2 m
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors can be found
in the Accessories brochure.
E 18.343.2/11.13
252
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
welded
hex.-SW27
12
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869
E 18.343.2/11.13
253
12
254
E 18.343.2/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4100
CSA Intrinsically safe
CSA Non Incendive
Weight ~ 180 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and short circuit
protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
B.F.S.L.= Best Fit Straight Line
1)
psi pressure ranges on request
2)
-20°C with FPM or EPDM seal, -40° on request
3)
500 V AC on request 255
Pin connections: Areas of application:
Conduit (single cores) Group 1 2 3 4
Protection Intrinsically safe Intrinsically safe Non incendive Non incendive
Type (with field cabling)
Gases and dusts Gases Gases Gases and dusts
Certificate CSA 1760344
Intrinsically safe Intrinsically safe Non incendive Non incendive
Electrical 9, A 5, 9, A 5, 9, A 9
Connection
Code for A B C
Model Code
Model code:
HDA 4 1 4 X – A – XXXX – C N X – 000 – X 1 (2m)
Pin HDA 41X5-A HDA 41XA-A
1 Signal + Signal + Mechanical connection
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
2 Signal - Signal - Electrical connection
3 n.c. n.c. 5 = Male, 3 pole+ PE,
EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
^ Housing Housing (connector supplied)
9 = Conduit connection thread
12 (1/2-14 NPT, male)
A = Male EN175301-803
(DIN 43650), 3 pole + PE
(1/2’’ conduit female thread)
Signal
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
Pressure ranges in bar
01.0; 02.5
Approval
C = CSA
Insulation voltage
N = 50 V AC
Protection types and applications (code)
A = Group 1
B = Group 2 and 3
C = Group 4
Modification number
000 = Standard
Seal material (in contact with fluid)
F = FPM seal (e.g.: for hydraulic oils)
E = EPDM seal (e.g.: for refrigerants)
Material of connection (in contact with fluid)
1 = Stainless steel
Cable length in m (only for electr. connection type 9)
Standard = 2 m
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors can be found
in the Accessories brochure.
E 18.344.2/11.13
256
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
welded
hex.-SW27
12
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869
E 18.344.2/11.13
257
12
258
E 18.344.2/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4700
IECEx Intrinsically Safe
IECEx Dustproof Enclosure
IECEx Non-sparking
Weight ~ 150 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage,
override and short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to the full measuring range, B.F.S.L.= Best Fit Straight Line
1)
1000 bar only with mechanical connection G 1/2 DIN 3852 and vice versa
2)
-20 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
3)
500 V AC on request
259
Areas of application:
Protection types Ex ta lllC T80 °C
Ex ia IIC T6 Ga Ex ic llC T6 Gc
and Ex ia I Ma Ex ia IIC T6 Gb Ex nA llC T6 Gc T500T90 °C Da Ex ia lIIC T85 °C Da
Ex ia IIC T6 Ga/Gb Ex ic lllC T80 °C Dc
applications Ex tb lllC T80 °C Db
Electrical connection 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 6 6 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6
1 ü ü ü ü ü
9 ü ü
A ü ü
C ü ü
D ü ü ü ü ü
Devices in the ignition protection class "Dustproof enclosure" for the protection types Ex ta lllC T80/90/100 °C Da T500T90/T100/T110°C Da, Ex tb lllC
T80/90/100 °C Db and Ex tc lllC T80/90/100 °C Dc are available with flying leads on request. Devices in the ignition protection class "non-sparking" for
protection type Ex nA llC T6, T5, T4 Gc are available with flying leads on request.
Model code:
HDA 4 7 X X – A – XXXX – I N X – 000
Mechanical connection
2 = G1/2 DIN 3852
(only for "1000 bar" pressure range)
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male)
Electrical connection
4 = Male 4 pole Binder series 714 M18 (connector not supplied)
5 = Male 3 pole + PE, EN175301-803 (DIN 43650) (connector supplied)
12 6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole (connector not supplied)
Signal
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
Pressure ranges in bar
0009 (-1..9); 0006; 0016; 0040; 0060; 0100; 0250; 0400; 0600;
1000 (only in conjunction with mechanical connection type "2")
Approval
I = IECEx
Insulation voltage
N = 50 V AC
Protection types and applications (code)
1 = Ex ia l Ma
Ex ia llC T6 Ga
Ex ia llC T6 Ga/Gb
Ex ia llC T6 Gb
9 = Ex nA llC T6 Gc (only in conjunction with electr. connection "6")*
A = Ex ta lllC T80 °C T500T90 °C Da (only in conjunction with electr. connection "6")*
Ex tb lllC T80 °C Db
C = Ex ic llC T6 Gc
Ex ic lllC T80 °C Dc
D = Ex ia l Ma
Ex ia llC T6 Ga
Ex ia llC T6 Ga/Gb
Ex ia llC T6 Gb
Ex ia lllC T85 °C Da
Modification number
000 = Standard
Notes:
* For design and electrical connection see Dimensions
E 18.392.1/11.13
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical female connectors, can be found in the Accessories brochure.
260
Dimensions: Pin connections:
Protection types and applications: (code): 1, C, D Binder series 714 M18
profile seal
ring
hex-SW27
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869
Pin HDA 47x5-A
1 Signal +
2 Signal -
hex-SW27
3 n.c.
^ Housing
elastomer 12
profile gasket M12x1
DIN 3869
optional
O-ring
20.35 x 1.78
Impact
protected metal
safety sleeve
SW25
hex-
SW27
E 18.392.1/11.13
The impact protected metal safety sleeve is included. A straight female connector is
required for electrical connection, e.g. female connector M12x1, 4 pole, straight, with
3m shielded cable: ZBE 06S-03, Part No. 6098243
261
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
12
E 18.392.1/11.13
262
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4400
IECEx Intrinsically Safe
IECEx Dustproof Enclosure
IECEx Non-sparking
263
Areas of application:
Protection types Ex ta lllC T80 °C
Ex ia IIC T6 Ga Ex ic llC T6 Gc
and Ex ia I Ma Ex ia IIC T6 Gb Ex nA llC T6 Gc T500T90 °C Da Ex ia lIIC T85 °C Da
Ex ia IIC T6 Ga/Gb Ex ic lllC T80 °C Dc
applications Ex tb lllC T80 °C Db
Equipment protec- Equipment protec- Equipment pro- Equipment protec- Equipment protec- Equipment protection Equipment protec-
tion level tion level tection level tion evel tion level level tion level
Ma Ga, Ga/Gb Gb Gc Da, Db Gc, Dc Da
Zones /
Mining Gases Gases Gases Conductive dust Gases/conductive dust Conductive dust
Categories
Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class:
intrinsically safe ia intrinsically safe ia intrinsically safe ia non-sparking nA Dustproof Intrinsically safe ic intrinsically safe ia
with barrier with barrier with barrier enclosure with barrier with barrier
Electrical connection 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 6 6 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6
1 ü ü ü ü ü
9 ü ü
A ü ü
C ü ü
D ü ü ü ü ü
Devices in the ignition protection class "Dustproof enclosure" for the protection types Ex ta lllC T80/90/100 °C Da T500T90/T100/T110°C Da, Ex tb lllC
T80/90/100 °C Db and Ex tc lllC T80/90/100 °C Dc are available with flying leads on request. Devices in the ignition protection class "non-sparking" for
protection types Ex nA llC T6, T5, T4 Gc are available with flying leads on request.
Model code:
HDA 4 4 X X – A – XXXX – I N X – 000
Mechanical connection
2 = G1/2 DIN 3852 (only for "1000 bar" pressure range)
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852
Electrical connection
4 = Male 4 pole Binder series 714 M18 (connector not supplied)
5 = Male 3 pole + PE, EN 175301-803 (DIN 43650) (connector supplied)
6 = Male M12x1, 4 pole (connector not supplied)
12 Signal
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
Pressure ranges in bar
0016; 0060; 0100; 0250; 0400; 0600
1000 (only in conjunction with mechanical connection type "2")
Approval
I = IECEx
Insulation voltage
N = 50 V AC
Protection types and applications (code)
1 = Ex ia l Ma
Ex ia llC T6 Ga
Ex ia llC T6 Ga/Gb
Ex ia llC T6 Gb
9 = Ex nA llC T6 Gc (only in conjunction with electr. connection "6")*
A = Ex ta lllC T80 °C T500T90 °C Da (only in conjunction with electr. connection "6")*
Ex tb lllC T80 °C Db
C = Ex ic llC T6 Gc
Ex ic lllC T80 °C Dc
D = Ex ia l Ma
Ex ia llC T6 Ga
Ex ia llC T6 Ga/Gb
Ex ia llC T6 Gb
Ex ia lllC T85 °C Da
Modification number
000 = Standard
Notes:
*For design and electrical connection see Dimensions
E 18.392.1.0/11.13
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the Accessories brochure.
264
Dimensions: Pin connections:
Protection types and applications: (code): 1, C, D Binder series 714 M18
hex-SW27
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869
elastomer 12
profile gasket
DIN 3869
optional
M12x1, 4 pole
O-ring
20.35 x 1.78
Impact
protected metal
safety sleeve
SW25
hex-
SW27
E 18.392.1.0/11.13
The impact protected metal safety sleeve is included. A straight female connector is
required for electrical connection, e.g. female connector M12x1, 4 pole, straight, with
3m shielded cable: ZBE 06S-03, Part No. 6098243
265
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
12
E 18.392.1.0/11.13
266
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4300
IECEx Intrinsically Safe
IECEx Dustproof Enclosure
IECEx Non-sparking
267
Areas of application:
Protection types Ex ta lllC T80°C
Ex ia IIC T6 Ga Ex ic llC T6 Gc
and Ex ia I Ma Ex ia IIC T6 Gb Ex nA llC T6 Gc T500T90°C Da Ex ia lIIC T85° C Da
Ex ia IIC T6 Ga/Gb Ex ic lllC T80°C Dc
applications Ex tb lllC T80°C Db
Equipment level Equipment level Equipment level Equipment level Equipment level Equipment level Equipment level
standard standard standard standard standard standard standard
Ma Ga, Ga/Gb Gb Gc Da, Db Gc, Dc Da
Zones / Mining Gases Gases Gases Conductive dust Gases/conductive dust Conductive dust
Categories Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class:
intrinsically intrinsically safe ia intrinsically safe ia non-sparking nA Dustproof Intrinsically safe ic intrinsically safe ia
safe ia with barrier with barrier enclosure with barrier with barrier
with barrier
Electrical connection 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 6 6 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6
1 ü ü ü ü ü
9 ü ü
A ü ü
C ü ü
D ü ü ü ü ü
Devices in the ignition protection class "Dustproof enclosure" for the protection types Ex ta lllC T80/90/100° C Da T500T90/T100/T110°C Da, Ex tb lllC
T80/90/100°C Db and Ex tc lllC T80/90/100°C Dc are available with flying leads on request. Devices in the ignition protection class "non-sparking" for
protection type Ex nA llC T6, T5, T4 Gc are available with flying leads on request.
Model code:
HDA 4 3 4 X – A – XXXX – I N X – 000 – X 1
Mechanical connection
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852
Electrical connection
4 = Male, 4 pole Binder series 714 M18 (connector not supplied)
5 = Male, 3 pole + PE, EN 175301-803 (DIN 43650) (connector supplied)
6 = Male, M12x1, 4 pole (connector not supplied)
Signal
12 A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
Pressure ranges in bar
0001 (-1..1); 01.0; 02.5; 04.0; 06.0; 0010; 0016; 0025; 0040
Approval
I = IECEx
Insulation voltage
N = 50 V AC
Protection types and applications (code)
1 = Ex ia l Ma
Ex ia llC T6 Ga
Ex ia llC T6 Ga/Gb
Ex ia llC T6 Gb
9 = Ex nA llC T6 Gc (only in conjunction with electr. connection “6“)*
A = Ex ta lllC T80°C T500T90°C Da (only in conjunction with electr. connection 6")*
Ex tb lllC T80°C Db
C = Ex ic llC T6 Gc
Ex ic lllC T80°C Dc
D = Ex ia l Ma
Ex ia llC T6 Ga
Ex ia llC T6 Ga/Gb
Ex ia llC T6 Gb
Ex ia lllC T85°C Da
Modification number
000 = Standard
Seal material (in contact with fluid)
F = FPM seal (e.g.: for hydraulic oils)
E = EPDM seal (e.g.: for refrigerants)
Material of connection (in contact with fluid)
1 = Stainless steel
Notes:
E 18.392.3.0/11.13
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the Accessories brochure.
268
Dimensions: Pin connections:
Protection types and applications (code): 1, C, D Binder series 714 M18
hex.-SW27
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869
12
M12x1, 4 pole
Impact
protected metal
safety sleeve
SW25
hex.-SW27
E 18.392.3.0/11.13
The impact protected metal safety sleeve is included. A straight female connector is
required for electrical connection; e.g. female connector M12x1, 4 pole, straight, with
3m shielded cable: ZBE 06S-03, Part No. 6098243
269
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
12
E 18.392.3.0/11.13
270
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4100
IECEx Intrinsically Safe
IECEx Dustproof Enclosure
IECEx Non-sparking
271
Areas of application:
Protection types Ex ta lllC T80°C
Ex ia IIC T6 Ga Ex ic llC T6 Gc
and Ex ia I Ma Ex ia IIC T6 Gb Ex nA llC T6 Gc T500T90°C Da Ex ia lIIC T85° C Da
Ex ia IIC T6 Ga/Gb Ex ic lllC T80°C Dc
applications Ex tb lllC T80°C Db
Equipment level Equipment level Equipment level Equipment level Equipment level Equipment level Equipment level
standard standard standard standard standard standard standard
Ma Ga, Ga/Gb Gb Gc Da, Db Gc, Dc Da
Zones / Mining Gases Gases Gases Conductive dust Gases/conductive dust Conductive dust
Categories Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class:
intrinsically intrinsically safe ia intrinsically safe ia non-sparking nA Dustproof Intrinsically safe ic intrinsically safe ia
safe ia with barrier with barrier enclosure with barrier with barrier
with barrier
Electrical connection 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 6 6 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6
1 ü ü ü ü ü
9 ü ü
A ü ü
C ü ü
D ü ü ü ü ü
Devices in the ignition protection class "Dustproof enclosure" for the protection types Ex ta lllC T80/90/100° C Da T500T90/T100/T110°C Da, Ex tb lllC
T80/90/100°C Db and Ex tc lllC T80/90/100°C Dc are available with flying leads on request. Devices in the ignition protection class "non-sparking" for
protection type Ex nA llC T6, T5, T4 Gc are available with flying leads on request.
Model code:
HDA 4 1 4 X – A – XXXX – I N X – 000 – X 1
Mechanical connection
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852
Electrical connection
4 = Male, 4 pole Binder series 714 M18 (connector not supplied)
5 = Male, 3 pole + PE, EN 175301-803 (DIN 43650) (connector supplied)
6 = Male, M12x1, 4 pole (connector not supplied)
Signal
12 A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
Pressure ranges in bar
01.0; 02.5;
Approval
I = IECEx
Insulation voltage
N = 50 V AC
Protection types and applications (code)
1 = Ex ia l Ma
Ex ia llC T6 Ga
Ex ia llC T6 Ga/Gb
Ex ia llC T6 Gb
9 = Ex nA llC T6 Gc (only in conjunction with electr. connection “6“)*
A = Ex ta lllC T80°C T500T90°C Da (only in conjunction with electr. connection "6")*
Ex tb lllC T80°C Db
C = Ex ic llC T6 Gc
Ex ic lllC T80°C Dc
D = Ex ia l Ma
Ex ia llC T6 Ga
Ex ia llC T6 Ga/Gb
Ex ia llC T6 Gb
Ex ia lllC T85°C Da
Modification number
000 = Standard
Seal material (in contact with fluid)
F = FPM seal (e.g.: for hydraulic oils)
E = EPDM seal (e.g.: for refrigerants)
Material of connection (in contact with fluid)
1 = Stainless steel
Notes:
E 18.392.2.0/11.13
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the Accessories brochure.
272
Dimensions: Pin connections:
Protection types and applications: (code): 1, C, D Binder series 714 M18
hex.-SW27
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869
12
M12x1, 4 pole
Impact protected
metal safety
sleeve
SW25
hex.-SW27
E 18.392.2.0/11.13
The impact protected metal safety sleeve is included. A straight female connector is
required for electrical connection; e.g. female connector M12x1, 4 pole, straight, with
3m shielded cable: ZBE 06S-03, Part No. 6098243
273
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
12
E 18.392.2.0/11.13
274
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4700
with Flush Membrane
ATEX Intrinsically Safe
ATEX Dustproof Enclosure
ATEX Non-sparking
Description: Technical data:
The pressure transmitter HDA 4700 in Input data
ATEX version with flush membrane has Measuring ranges 40; 60; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
been specially developed for use in Overload ranges 80; 120; 200; 500; 800; 900 bar
potentially explosive atmospheres. Burst pressure 1) 200; 300; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000 bar
Like the standard model, the HDA 4700 Mechanical connection G1/2 A DIN 3852
G1/2 with additional front O-ring seal
with flush membrane has a stainless steel
Pressure transfer fluid Silicon-free oil
measurement cell with a thin film strain
Torque value 45 Nm
gauge.
Parts in contact with medium 2) Stainless steel: 1.4435; 1.4301
The pressure connection is achieved Seal: FPM
with an all-welded stainless steel O-ring: FPM
front membrane filled internally with Output data
a pressure transfer fluid. The process Output signal, permitted load resistance 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
RLmax = (UB – 12 V) / 20 mA [kΩ]
pressure is transmitted hydrostatically to
Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ.
the measurement cell via the pressure max. setting ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
transfer fluid. Accuracy at minimum setting ≤ ± 0.15 % FS typ.
This device is used for applications in (B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.25 % FS max.
which a standard pressure connection Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.008 % FS / °C typ.
Zero point ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C max.
could become blocked, clogged or 12
Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.008 % FS / °C typ.
frozen by the particular medium used. Over range ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C max.
Further applications include processes Non-linearity at max. setting ≤ ± 0.3 % FS max.
where the medium changes regularly to DIN 16086
and any residues could cause mixing Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.
or contamination of the media, or in Repeatability ≤ ± 0.05 % FS
highly viscous media. Intended areas of Rise time ≤ 1.5 ms
application are, for example, the oil and Long term drift ≤ ± 0.1 % FS typ. / year
gas industry, in mines or in locations with Environmental conditions
high levels of dust, e.g. in mills. Compensated temperature range -20 .. +85 °C
Operating temperature range3) -40 .. +60 °C / -20 .. +60 °C
Protection types and applications: Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
I M1 Ex ia I Ma Fluid temperature range3) -40 .. +60 °C / -20 .. +60 °C
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
II 1G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga EN 60079-0 / 11 / 26 / 31
II 1/2G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga/Gb EN 50303
II 2G Ex ia IIC T6 Gb Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g
DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
II 3G Ex nA llC T6,T5,T4 Gc
Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65 (for male EN 175301-803(DIN 43650))
II 3G Ex ic llC T6,T5,T4 Gc IP 67 (for M12x1 male, when an
IP 67 female connector is used)
II 1D Ex ia lIIC T85 °C Da Relevant data for Ex applications Ex ia, ic Ex nA, ta, tb, tc
II 1D Ex ta lllC T80/90/100 °C Da Supply voltage Ui = 12 .. 28 V 12 .. 28 V
Max. input current Ii = 100 mA
T500T90/T100/T110 °C Da Max. input power Pi = 1 W max. power consuption
II 2D Ex tb lllC T80/90/100 °C Db ≤1W
II 3D Ex tc lllC T80/T90/T100 °C Dc Connection capacitance of the sensor Ci = ≤ 22 nF
Inductance of the sensor Li = 0 mH
II 3D Ex ic lllC T80/T90/T100 °C Dc Insulation voltage 4) 50 V AC, with integrated overvoltage protection
EN 61000-6-2
Special features: Other data
Pressure connection has a flush Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Life expectancy > 10 million cycles
membrane 0 .. 100 % FS
Accuracy ≤ 0.25 % typ. Weight ~ 180 g
Certificates: Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and short circuit protection are
provided.
KEMA 05ATEX1016 X FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
KEMA 05ATEX1021 B.F.S.L. = Best Fit Straight Line
E 18.374.1.0/11.13
Robust design
1)
G1/2 with additional front O-ring seal max. 1500 bar
2)
Other seal materials on request
Very small temperature error 3)
-20 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
4)
500 V AC on request
Excellent EMC characteristics
Excellent long-term properties
275
Areas of application:
Code used in
1 9 A C
Model code
Protection type II 1D Ex ta lllC T80°C
II 1G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga II 3G Ex ic llC T6 Gc
T500T90°C Da
I M1 Ex ia I Ma II 1/2G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga/Gb II 2G Ex ia IIC T6 Gb II 3G Ex nA llC T6 Gc II 3D Ex ic lllC T80°C Dc
II 1D Ex ia lIIC T85°C Da
II 2D Ex tb lllC T80°C Db
Certificate KEMA 05ATEX1016 X / KEMA 05ATEX1021
Group I Group II, lll Group II Group II Group IIl Group II, lll
Category M1 Category 1G, 1/2G, 1D Category 2G Category 3G Category 1D, 2D Category 3G, 3D
Zones / Mining Gases/conductive dust Gases Gases Conductive dust Gases/conductive dust
Categories Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class:
intrinsically safe intrinsically safe ia intrinsically safe ia Non-sparking nA Dustproof enclosure Intrinsically safe ic
ia with barrier with barrier with barrier with barrier
Electrical 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 6 6 4,5,6
Connection
(see model code)
Devices in ignition protection class "Dustproof enclosure" for the protection types II 1D Ex ta lllC T80/90/100° C Da T500T90/T100/T110°C Da, II 2D Ex tb lllC T80/90/100°C Db
and ll 3D Ex tc lllC T80/90/100°C Dc are available with flying leads on request.
Devices in the ignition protection class "Non-sparking" for the protection type II 3G Ex nA llC T6, T5, T4 Gc are available with flying leads on request.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical female connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
E 18.374.1.0/11.13
276
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
Protection types and applications (code): 1, C the operating conditions and
applications described.
~ 35
For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
̴ 35.5
M3
27.5
□ 18 M12x1
12.3
12
Ø 35
59.4
Ø 27
hex-
SW27
3
13.8
Elastomer profile
seal ring DIN3869
G1/2 A
Ø 26 h14
Ø 29.5
12
hex-
SW27
3
O-ring 15 x 2
Ø 18.1
G1/2 A
Ø 26 h14
Ø 29.5
Impact
protected metal
safety sleeve
SW25
hex-
SW27
E 18.374.1.0/11.13
277
12
278
E 18.374.1.0/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4400
with Flush Membrane
ATEX Intrinsically Safe
ATEX Dustproof Enclosure
ATEX Non-sparking
Description: Technical data:
The pressure transmitter HDA 4400 Input data
in ATEX version has been specially Measuring ranges 40; 60; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
developed for use in potentially explosive Overload ranges 80; 120; 200; 500; 800; 900 bar
atmospheres and is based on the Burst pressure 1) 200; 300; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000 bar
HDA 4000 series. Mechanical connection G1/2A DIN 3852
As with the industrial version, the G1/2 with add. front O-ring seal
G1/4 with add. front O-ring seal
HDA 4400 in ATEX version has a Pressure transfer fluid Silicon-free oil
stainless steel measurement cell with thin- Torque value 45 Nm for G1/2, G1/2 A
film strain gauge. 20 Nm for G1/4
The pressure connection is achieved Parts in contact with medium 2) Stainless steel: 1.4435; 1.4301
with an all-welded stainless steel Seal: FPM
O-ring: FPM
front membrane filled internally with Output data
a pressure transfer fluid. The process Output signal, permitted load resistance 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
pressure is transmitted hydrostatically to RLmax = (UB – 12 V) / 20 mA [kΩ]
the measurement cell via the pressure Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
transfer fluid. max. setting ≤ ± 1.0 % FS max.
This device is used for applications in Accuracy at minimum setting ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ.
(B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max. 12
which a standard pressure connection Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C typ.
could become blocked, clogged or Zero point ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max.
frozen by the particular medium used. Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C typ.
Further applications include processes Over range ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max.
where the medium changes regularly Non-linearity at max. setting to DIN 16086 ≤ ± 0.3 % FS max.
and any residues could cause mixing or Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.4 % FS max.
contamination of the media. Intended Repeatability ≤ ± 0.1 % FS
areas of application are, for example, Rise time ≤ 1.5 ms
the oil and gas industry, in mines, or in Long term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
locations with high levels of dust, Environmental conditions
e.g. in mills. Compensated temperature range -20 .. +85 °C
Operating temperature range -20 .. +60 °C
Protection types and applications: Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
I M1 Ex ia I Ma Fluid temperature range3) -40 .. +60 °C / -20 .. +60 °C
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
II 1G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga EN 60079-0 / 11 / 26 / 31
II 1/2G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga/Gb EN 50303
II 2G Ex ia IIC T6 Gb Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g
II 3G Ex nA llC T6,T5,T4 Gc DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 ..500 Hz
II 3G Ex ic llC T6,T5,T4 Gc Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65 (for male EN 175301-803(DIN 43650))
IP 67 (for M12x1 male, when an
IP 67 female connector is used)
II 1D Ex ia lIIC T85 °C Da Relevant data for Ex applications Ex ia, ic Ex nA, ta, tb, tc
II 1D Ex ta lllC T80/90/100 °C Da Supply voltage Ui = 12 .. 28 V 12 .. 28 V
T500T90/T100/T110 °C Da Max. input current Ii = 100 mA
Max. input power Pi = 1 W max. power consuption
II 2D Ex tb lllC T80/90/100 °C Db ≤1W
II 3D Ex tc lllC T80/T90/T100 °C Dc Connection capacitance of the sensor Ci = ≤ 22 nF
II 3D Ex ic lllC T80/T90/T100 °C Dc Inductance of the sensor Li = 0 mH
Insulation voltage 4) 50 V AC, with integrated overvoltage protection
Special features: EN 61000-6-2
Pressure connection has a flush Other data
membrane Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Life expectancy > 10 million cycles
Accuracy ≤ 0.5 % typ. 0 .. 100 % FS
Certificates: Weight ~ 180 g
KEMA 05ATEX1016 X
E 18.375.1.0/11.13
KEMA 05ATEX1021 Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and short circuit protection are
provided.
Robust design FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
Very small temperature error B.F.S.L. = Best Fit Straight Line
1)
G1/2 with additional front O-ring seal max. 1500 bar
Excellent EMC characteristics 2)
Other seal materials on request
3)
-20 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
Excellent long-term properties 4)
500 V AC on request
279
Areas of application:
Code used in
1 9 A C
Model code
Protection type II 1D Ex ta lllC T80°C
II 1G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga II 3G Ex ic llC T6 Gc
T500T90°C Da
I M1 Ex ia I Ma II 1/2G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga/Gb II 2G Ex ia IIC T6 Gb II 3G Ex nA llC T6 Gc II 3D Ex ic lllC T80°C Dc
II 1D Ex ia lIIC T85°C Da
II 2D Ex tb lllC T80°C Db
Certificate KEMA 05ATEX1016 X / KEMA 05ATEX1021
Group I Group II, lll Group II Group II Group IIl Group II, lll
Category M1 Category 1G, 1/2G, 1D Category 2G Category 3G Category 1D, 2D Category 3G, 3D
Mining Gases/conductive dust Gases Gases Conductive dust Gases/conductive dust
Zones / Protection Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class:
Categories class: intrinsically safe ia intrinsically safe ia Non-sparking nA Dustproof enclosure Intrinsically safe ic
intrinsically with barrier with barrier with barrier
safe ia
with barrier
Electrical 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 6 6 4,5,6
Connection
(see model code)
Devices in ignition protection class "Dustproof enclosure" for the protection types II 1D Ex ta lllC T80/90/100° C Da T500T90/T100/T110°C Da, II 2D Ex tb lllC T80/90/100°C Db
and ll 3D Ex tc lllC T80/90/100°C Dc are available with flying leads on request.
Devices in the ignition protection class "Non-sparking" for the protection type II 3G Ex nA llC T6, T5, T4 Gc are available with flying leads on request.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical female connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
E 18.375.1.0/11.13
280
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
Protection types and applications (code): 1, C the operating conditions and
~ 35 applications described.
For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
̴ 35.5
M3
27.5
□ 18 M12x1
12.3
12
Ø 35
59.4
Ø 27
hex-
SW27
Elastomer profile
3
13.8
12
hex-SW27 hex-SW27
3
2
10
8
Impact
protected metal
safety sleeve
SW25
hex-
SW27
E 18.375.1.0/11.13
The impact protected metal safety sleeve is included. HYDAC electronic GmbH
A straight female connector is required for electrical Hauptstraße 27, D-66128 Saarbrücken
connection. e.g. female connector M12x1, 4 pole, Telephone +49 (0)6897 509-01
straight, with 3m shielded cable: ZBE 06S-03, Fax +49 (0)6897 509-1726
Part. No. 6098243 E-mail: [email protected]
Internet: www.hydac.com
281
12
282
E 18.375.1.0/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4300
with Flush Membrane
ATEX Intrinsically Safe
ATEX Dustproof Enclosure
ATEX Non-sparking
Description: Technical data:
The pressure transmitter HDA 4300 Input data
in ATEX version has been specially Measuring ranges -1 .. 1; -1 .. 9; 1; 2.5; 4; 6; 10; 16; 25 bar
developed for use in potentially explosive Overload range 3; 32; 3; 8; 12; 20; 32; 50; 80 bar
atmospheres and is based on the Burst pressure 5; 48; 5; 12; 18; 30; 48; 75; 120 bar
HDA 4000 series. Mechanical connection G1/2A DIN 3852
G1/2 with additional front O-ring seal
As with the industrial version, the G1/4 with additional front O-ring seal
HDA 4300 in ATEX version has the field- Pressure transfer fluid Silicon-free oil
proven ceramic measurement cell with Torque value 45 Nm for G1/2, G1/2 A
thick-film strain gauge. 20 Nm for G1/4
Parts in contact with medium 1) Stainless steel: 1.4435; 1.4301
The pressure connection is achieved Seal: FPM
with an all-welded stainless steel O-ring: FPM
front membrane filled internally with Output data
a pressure transfer fluid. The process Output signal, permitted load resistance 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
pressure is transmitted hydrostatically to RLmax = (UB – 12 V) / 20 mA [kΩ]
the measurement cell via the pressure Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
max. setting ≤ ± 1.0 % FS max.
transfer fluid. Accuracy at minimum setting ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ.
This device is used for applications in (B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
which a standard pressure connection Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.02 % FS / °C typ. 12
Zero point ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max.
could become blocked, clogged or
Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.02 % FS / °C typ.
frozen by the particular medium used. Over range ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max.
Further applications include processes Non-linearity at max. setting to
≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
where the medium changes regularly DIN 16086
and any residues could cause mixing or Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.4 % FS max.
contamination of the media. Intended Repeatability ≤ ± 0.1 % FS
areas of application are, for example, Rise time ≤ 1.5 ms
the oil and gas industry, in mines, or in Long term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
locations with high levels of dust, Environmental conditions
e.g. in mills. Compensated temperature range -20 .. +85 °C
Operating temperature range -20 .. +60 °C
Protection types and applications: Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
I M1 Ex ia I Ma Fluid temperature range2) -40 .. +60 °C / -20 .. +60 °C
- mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
II 1G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga EN 60079-0 / 11 / 26 / 31
EN 50303
II 1/2G Ex ia IIC T6 Ga/Gb Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g
II 2G Ex ia IIC T6 Gb DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 ..500 Hz
II 3G Ex nA llC T6,T5,T4 Gc Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65 (for male EN 175301-803(DIN 43650))
II 3G Ex ic llC T6,T5,T4 Gc IP 67 (for M12x1 male, when an
IP 67 female connector is used)
II 1D Ex ia lIIC T85°C Da Relevant data for Ex applications Ex ia, ic Ex nA, ta, tb, tc
Supply voltage Ui = 12 .. 28 V 12 .. 28 V
II 1D Ex ta lllC T80/90/100°C Da Max. input current Ii = 100 mA
T500T90/T100/T110°C Da Max. input power Pi = 1 W max. power consuption
II 2D Ex tb lllC T80/90/100°C Db ≤1W
Connection capacitance of the sensor Ci = ≤ 22 nF
II 3D Ex tc lllC T80/T90/T100°C Dc Inductance of the sensor Li = 0 mH
II 3D Ex ic lllC T80/T90/T100°C Dc Insulation voltage 3) 50 V AC, with integrated overvoltage protection
EN 61000-6-2
Other data
Special features: Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Pressure connection has a flush Life expectancy > 10 million cycles
0 .. 100 % FS
membrane Weight ~ 180 g
Accuracy: ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ. Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and short circuit protection are
provided.
Certificates: FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
E 18.376.3.0/11.13
Devices in ignition protection class "Dustproof enclosure" for the protection types II 1D Ex ta lllC T80/90/100° C Da T500T90/T100/T110°C Da, II 2D Ex tb lllC T80/90/100°C Db
and ll 3D Ex tc lllC T80/90/100°C Dc are available with flying leads on request.
Devices in the ignition protection class "Non-sparking" for the protection type II 3G Ex nA llC T6, T5, T4 Gc are available with flying leads on request.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical female connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
E 18.376.3.0/11.13
284
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
Protection types and applications (code): 1, C the operating conditions and
~ 35 applications described.
For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
̴ 35.5
M3
27.5
□ 18 M12x1
12.3
12
Ø 35
61.4
Ø 27
hex-SW27
3
13.8
Elastomer profile
seal ring DIN3869
G1/2 A
Ø 26 h14
Ø 29.5
12
hex-SW27 hex-SW27
3
8
10
Impact
protected metal
safety sleeve
SW25
hex-SW27
E 18.376.3.0/11.13
The impact protected metal safety sleeve is included. HYDAC electronic GmbH
A straight female connector is required for electrical Hauptstraße 27, D-66128 Saarbrücken
connection. e.g. female connector M12x1, 4 pole, Telephone +49 (0)6897 509-01
straight, with 3m shielded cable: ZBE 06S-03, Fax +49 (0)6897 509-1726
Part. No. 6098243 E-mail: [email protected]
Internet: www.hydac.com
285
12
286
E 18.376.3.0/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4700
with Flush Membrane
IECEx Intrinsically Safe
IECEx Dustproof Enclosure
IECEx Non-sparking
Description: Technical data:
The pressure transmitter HDA 4700 in Input data
IECEx Intrinsically Safe version has been Measuring ranges 40; 60; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
especially developed for use in potentially Overload ranges 80; 120; 200; 500; 800; 900 bar
explosive atmospheres and is based on Burst pressure1) 200; 300; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000 bar
the HDA 4000 series. Mechanical connection G1/2 A DIN 3852
As with the industrial version of the G1/2 with additional front O-ring seal
HDA 4700, devices with IECEx Pressure transfer fluid Silicon-free oil
Intrinsically Safe approval have a Torque value 45 Nm
field-proven, all-welded stainless steel Parts in contact with medium 2) Stainless steel: 1.4435; 1.4301
measurement cell with thin-film strain Seal: FPM
gauge without internal seal. O-ring: FPM
The pressure connection is achieved Output data
with an all-welded stainless steel Output signal, permitted load resistance 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
front membrane filled internally with RLmax = (UB – 12 V) / 20 mA [kΩ]
a pressure transfer fluid. The process Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ.
pressure is transmitted hydrostatically to max. setting ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
the measurement cell via the pressure Accuracy at minimum setting ≤ ± 0.15 % FS typ.
transfer fluid. (B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.25 % FS max.
Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.008 % FS / °C typ. 12
This device is used for applications in zero point ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C max.
which a standard pressure connection Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.008 % FS / °C typ.
could become blocked, clogged or over range ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C max.
frozen by the particular medium used. Non-linearity at max. setting ≤ ± 0.3 % FS max.
Further applications include processes to DIN 16086
where the medium changes regularly Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.
and any residues could cause mixing Repeatability ≤ ± 0.05 % FS
or contamination of the media, or in
Rise time ≤ 1.5 ms
highly viscous media. Intended areas of
Long term drift ≤ ± 0.1 % FS typ. / year
application are, for example, the oil and
Environmental conditions
gas industry, in mines or in locations with
Compensated temperature range -20 .. +85 °C
high levels of dust, e.g. in mills.
Operating temperature range 3) -40 .. +60 °C / -20 .. +60 °C
Protection types and applications: Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
Ex ia l Ma Fluid temperature range 3) -40 .. +60 °C / -20 .. +60 °C
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Ex ia llC T6 Ga EN 60079-0 / 11 / 26 / 36
Ex ia llC T6 Ga/Gb Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g
Ex ia llC T6 Gb DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 ..500 Hz
Ex nA llC T6,T5,T4 Gc Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65 (for male EN 175301-803 (DIN 43650))
Ex ic llC T6,T5,T4 Gc IP 67 (for M12x1 male, when an
IP 67 female connector is used)
Ex ta lllC T80/90/100°C Da Relevant data for Ex applications Ex ia, ic Ex nA, ta, tb, tc
T500 90/100/110°C Da Supply voltage Ui = 12 .. 28 V 12 .. 28 V
Max. input current Ii = 100 mA
Ex tb lllC T80/90/100°C Db Max. input power Pi = 1 W max. power consuption
Ex tc lllC T80/90/100°C Dc ≤1W
Ex ic lllC T80/90/100°C Dc Connection capacitance of the sensor Ci = ≤ 22 nF
Ex ia lllC T85°C Da Inductance of the sensor Li = 0 mH
Insulation voltage 4) 50 V AC, with integrated overvoltage protection
EN 61000-6-2
Special features: Other data
Pressure connection has a flush Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
membrane Life expectancy > 10 million cycles
0 .. 100 % FS
Accuracy ≤ 0.25 % FS typ. Weight ~ 180 g
Certificate: Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and short circuit protection are
IECEx KEM 08.0014X provided.
E 18.374.3.0/11.13
287
Areas of application:
Code used in
D 9 A C
Model code
Protection types Ex ia IIC T6 Ga Ex ta lllC T80 °C
Ex ic llC T6 Gc
and Ex ia I Ma Ex ia IIC T6 Ga/Gb Ex ia IIC T6 Gb Ex nA llC T6 Gc T500T90 °C Da
Ex ic lllC T80 °C Dc
applications Ex ia lIIC T85 °C Da Ex tb lllC T80 °C Db
Certificate IECEx KEM 08.0014X
Equipment Equipment protection level Equipment Equipment Equipment protection Equipment protection
protection level Ma Ga, Ga/Gb, Da protection level Gb protection level Gc level Da, Db level Gc, Dc
Zones / Mining Gases/conductive dust Gases Gases Conductive dust Gases/conductive dust
Categories Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class:
intrinsically safe ia intrinsically safe ia intrinsically safe ia Non-sparking nA Dustproof enclosure Intrinsically safe ic
with barrier with barrier with barrier with barrier
Electrical 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 6 6 4,5,6
Connection
Devices in ignition protection class "Dustproof enclosure" for the protection types Ex ta lllC T80/90/100 °C Da T500T90/T100/T110 °C Da, Ex tb lllC T80/90/100 °C Db and
Ex tc lllC T80/90/100 °C Dc are available with flying leads on request.
Devices in the ignition protection class "Non-sparking" for the protection type Ex nA llC T6, T5, T4 Gc are available with flying leads on request.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical female connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
E 18.374.3.0/11.13
288
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
Protection types and applications (code): D, C the operating conditions and
̴ 35 applications described.
For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
̴ 35.5
M3
27.5
□ 18 M12x1
12.3
12
Ø 35
59.4
Ø 27
hex-
SW27
3
13.8
Elastomer profile
seal ring DIN3869
G1/2 A
Ø 26 h14
Ø 29.5
12
hex-SW27
3
O-ring 15 x 2
Ø 18.1
G1/2 A
Ø 26 h14
Ø 29.5
Impact
protected metal
safety sleeve
SW25
hex-
SW27
E 18.374.3.0/11.13
The impact protected metal safety sleeve is included. HYDAC electronic GmbH
A straight female connector is required for electrical Hauptstraße 27, D-66128 Saarbrücken
connection. e.g. female connector M12x1, 4 pole, Telephone +49 (0)6897 509-01
straight, with 3m shielded cable: ZBE 06S-03, Fax +49 (0)6897 509-1726
Part. No. 6098243 E-mail: [email protected]
Internet: www.hydac.com
289
12
290
E 18.374.3.0/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4400
with Flush Membrane
IECEx Intrinsically Safe
IECEx Dustproof Enclosure
IECEx Non-sparking
Description: Technical data:
The pressure transmitter HDA 4400 in Input data
IECEx Intrinsically Safe version has been Measuring ranges 40; 60; 100; 250; 400; 600 bar
especially developed for use in potentially Overload pressures 80; 120; 200; 500; 800; 1000 bar
explosive atmospheres and is based on Burst pressure 1) 200; 300; 500; 1000; 2000; 2000 bar
the HDA 4000 series. Mechanical connection G1/2 A DIN 3852
As with the industrial version of the G1/2 with additional front O-ring seal
HDA 4400, devices with IECEx G1/4 with additional front O-ring seal
Intrinsically Safe approval have a Pressure transfer fluid Silicon-free oil
field-proven, all-welded stainless steel Torque value 45 Nm for G1/2, G1/2 A
measurement cell with thin film strain 20 Nm for G1/4
gauge without internal seal. Parts in contact with medium 2) Stainless steel: 1.4435; 1.4301
Seal: FPM
The pressure connection is achieved O-ring: FPM
with an all-welded stainless steel Output data
front membrane filled internally with Output signal, permitted load resistance 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
a pressure transfer fluid. The process RLmax = (UB – 12 V) / 20 mA [kΩ]
pressure is transmitted hydrostatically to Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
the measurement cell via the pressure max. setting ≤ ± 1 % FS max.
transfer fluid. Accuracy at minimum setting ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ.
(B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max. 12
This device is used for applications in Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C type
which a standard pressure connection Zero point ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max.
could become blocked, clogged or Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.015 % FS / °C typ.
frozen by the particular medium used. Over range ≤ ± 0.025 % FS / °C max.
Further applications include processes Non-linearity at max. setting ≤ ± 0.3 % FS max.
where the medium changes regularly to DIN 16086
and any residues could cause mixing Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.4 % FS max.
or contamination of the media, or in Repeatability ≤ ± 0.1 % FS
highly viscous media. Intended areas of Rise time ≤ 1.5 ms
application are, for example, the oil and Long term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
gas industry, in mines or in locations with Environmental conditions
high levls of dust, e.g. in mills. Compensated temperature range -20 .. +85 °C
Protection types and applications: Operating temperature range -20 .. +60 °C
Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
Ex ia l Ma
Fluid temperature range 3) -40 .. +60 °C / -20 .. +60 °C
Ex ia llC T6 Ga - mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
EN 60079-0 / 11 / 26 / 36
Ex ia llC T6 Ga/Gb
Ex ia llC T6 Gb Vibration resistance to ≤ 20 g
DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 ..500 Hz
Ex nA llC T6,T5,T4 Gc Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65 (for male EN 175301-803(DIN 43650))
Ex ic llC T6,T5,T4 Gc IP 67 (for M12x1 male, when an
IP 67 female connector is used)
Ex ta lllC T80/90/100 °C Da Relevant data for Ex applications Ex ia, ic Ex nA, ta, tb, tc
T500 90/100/110 °C Da Supply voltage Ui = 12 .. 28 V 12 .. 28 V
Ex tb lllC T80/90/100 °C Db Max. input current Ii = 100 mA
Ex tc lllC T80/90/100 °C Dc Max. input power Pi = 1 W max. power consuption
Ex ic lllC T80/90/100 °C Dc ≤1W
Connection capacitance of the sensor Ci = ≤ 22 nF
Ex ia lllC T85 °C Da Inductance of the sensor Li = 0 mH
Insulation voltage 4) 50 V AC, with integrated overvoltage protection
Special features: Other data
EN 61000-6-2
Pressure connection has a flush Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
membrane Life expectancy > 10 million cycles
Accuracy: ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ. 0 .. 100 % FS
Weight ~ 180 g
Certificate:
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and short circuit protection are
IECEx KEM 08.0014X provided.
E 18.392.4.0/11.13
291
Areas of application:
Code No.
for use in D 9 A C
Model code
Protection Ex ia IIC T6 Ga Ex ta lllC T80°C
Ex ic llC T6 Gc
types and Ex ia I Ma Ex ia IIC T6 Ga/Gb Ex ia IIC T6 Gb Ex nA llC T6 Gc T500T90°C Da
Ex ic lllC T80°C Dc
applications Ex ia lIIC T85°C Da Ex tb lllC T80°C Db
Certificate IECEx KEM 08.0014X
Equipment Equipment protection Equipment protection Equipment protection Equipment protection Equipment protection
protection level Ma level Ga, Ga/Gb, Da level Gb level Gc level Da, Db level Gc, Dc
Zones / Mining Gases/conductive dust Gases Gases Conductive dust Gases/conductive dust
Categories Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class:
intrinsically safe ia intrinsically safe ia intrinsically safe ia Non-sparking nA Dustproof enclosure Intrinsically safe ic
with barrier with barrier with barrier with barrier
Electrical 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 6 6 4,5,6
connection
Devices in ignition protection class "Dustproof enclosure" for the protection types Ex ta lllC T80/90/100 °C Da T500T90/T100/T110 °C Da, Ex tb lllC T80/90/100 °C Db and
Ex tc lllC T80/90/100 °C Dc are available with flying leads on request.
Devices in the ignition protection class "Non-sparking" for the protection type Ex nA llC T6, T5, T4 Gc are available with flying leads on request.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical female connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
E 18.392.4.0/11.13
292
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
Protection types and applications (code): D, C the operating conditions and applications
̴ 35 described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
̴ 35.5
M3
27.5
□ 18 M12x1
12.3
12
Ø 35
59.4
Ø 27
hex. SW27
3
13.8
Elastomer profile
seal ring DIN3869
G1/2 A
Ø 29 h14
Ø 29.5
12
hex. SW27 hex. SW27
2
20.5
8
10
Impact
protected metal
safety sleeve
SW25
hex. SW27
E 18.392.4.0/11.13
The impact protected metal safety sleeve is included. HYDAC electronic GmbH
A straight female connector is required for electrical Hauptstraße 27, D-66128 Saarbrücken
connection; e.g. female connector M12x1, 4 pole, Telephone +49 (0)6897 509-01
straight, with 3m shielded cable: ZBE 06S-03, Fax +49 (0)6897 509-1726
Part. No. 6098243 E-mail: [email protected]
Internet: www.hydac.com
293
12
294
E 18.392.4.0/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4300
with Flush Membrane
IECEx Intrinsically Safe
IECEx Dustproof Enclosure
IECEx Non-sparking
Description: Technical data:
The pressure transmitter HDA 4300 in Input data
IECEx Intrinsically Safe version has been Measuring ranges -1 .. 1;-1 .. 9;1; 2.5; 4; 6; 10; 16; 25 bar
especially developed for use in potentially Overload pressures 3; 32; 3; 8; 12; 20; 32; 50; 80 bar
explosive atmospheres and is based on Burst pressure 5; 48; 5; 12;18; 30; 48; 75; 120 bar
the HDA 4000 series. Mechanical connection G1/2 A DIN 3852
As with the industrial version HDA 4300, G1/2 with additional front O-ring seal
the devices with IECEx Intrinsically Safe G1/4 with additional front O-ring seal
approval have the field-proven ceramic Pressure transfer fluid Silicon-free oil
measuring cell with thick-film strain Torque value 45 Nm for G1/2, G1/2 A
20 Nm for G1/4
gauge.
Parts in contact with medium 1) Stainless steel: 1.4435; 1.4301
The pressure connection is achieved Seal: FPM
with an all-welded stainless steel O-ring: FPM
front membrane filled internally with Output data
a pressure transfer fluid. The process Output signal, permitted load resistance 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
pressure is transmitted hydrostatically to RLmax = (UB – 12 V) / 20 mA [kΩ]
the measurement cell via the pressure Accuracy to DIN 16086, ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
max. setting ≤ ± 1.0 % FS max.
transfer fluid. Accuracy at minimum setting ≤ ± 0.25 % FS typ.
This device is used for applications in (B.F.S.L.) ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
which a standard pressure connection Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.02 % FS / °C typ. 12
could become blocked, clogged or zero point ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max.
frozen by the particular medium used. Temperature compensation ≤ ± 0.02 % FS / °C typ.
Further applications include processes over range ≤ ± 0.03 % FS / °C max.
where the medium changes regularly Non-linearity at max. setting ≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.
to DIN 16086
and any residues could cause mixing or Hysteresis ≤ ± 0.4 % FS max.
contamination of the media. Intended Repeatability ≤ ± 0.1 % FS
areas of application are, for example,
Rise time ≤ 1.5 ms
the oil and gas industry, in mines, or in
Long term drift ≤ ± 0.3 % FS typ. / year
locations with high levels of dust,
Environmental conditions
e.g. in mills. Compensated temperature range -20 .. +85 °C
Operating temperature range -20 .. +60 °C
Protection types and applications: Storage temperature range -40 .. +100 °C
Ex ia l Ma Fluid temperature range 2) -40 .. +60 °C / -20 .. +60 °C
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Ex ia llC T6 Ga EN 60079-0 / 11 / 26 / 36
Ex ia llC T6 Ga/Gb Vibration resistance acc. to ≤ 20 g
Ex ia llC T6 Gb DIN EN 60068-2-6 at 10 .. 500 Hz
Ex nA llC T6,T5,T4 Gc Protection class to IEC 60529 IP 65 (for male EN 175301-803 (DIN 43650))
IP 67 (for M12x1 male, when an
Ex ic llC T6,T5,T4 Gc IP 67 female connector is used)
Relevant data for Ex applications Ex ia, ic Ex nA, ta, tb, tc
Ex ta lllC T80/90/100 °C Da Supply voltage Ui = 12 .. 28 V 12 .. 28 V
T500 90/100/110 °C Da Max. input current Ii = 100 mA
Ex tb lllC T80/90/100 °C Db Max. input power Pi = 1 W max. power consuption
Ex tc lllC T80/90/100 °C Dc ≤1W
Ex ic lllC T80/90/100 °C Dc Connection capacitance of the sensor Ci = ≤ 22 nF
Inductance of the sensor Li = 0 mH
Ex ia lllC T85 °C Da Insulation voltage 3) 50 V AC, with integrated overvoltage protection
EN 61000-6-2
Special features: Other data
Residual ripple of supply voltage ≤5%
Pressure connection has a flush Life expectancy > 10 million cycles
membrane 0 .. 100 % FS
Weight ~ 180 g
Accuracy: ≤ ± 0.5 % FS typ.
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and short circuit protection are
Certificate: provided.
IECEx KEM 08.0014X FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
E 18.376.2.0/11.13
295
Areas of application:
Code for use in
D 9 A C
Model code
Protection Ex ia IIC T6 Ga Ex ta lllC T80°C
Ex ic llC T6 Gc
types and Ex ia I Ma Ex ia IIC T6 Ga/Gb Ex ia IIC T6 Gb Ex nA llC T6 Gc T500T90°C Da
Ex ic lllC T80°C Dc
applications Ex ia lIIC T85°C Da Ex tb lllC T80°C Db
Certificate IECEx KEM 08.0014X
Equipment protec- Equipment protection Equipment protection Equipment protection Equipment protection Equipment protection
tion level Ma level Ga, Ga/Gb, Da level Gb level Gc level Da, Db level Gc, Dc
Zones / Mining Gases/conductive dust Gases Gases Conductive dust Gases/conductive dust
Categories Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class: Protection class:
intrinsically safe ia intrinsically safe ia intrinsically safe ia Non-sparking nA Dustproof enclosure Intrinsically safe ic
with barrier with barrier with barrier with barrier
Electrical 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6 6 6 4,5,6
Connection
Devices in the ignition protection class "Dustproof enclosure" for the protection types Ex ta lllC T80/90/100° C Da T500T90/T100/T110°C Da, Ex tb lllC T80/90/100°C Db and
Ex tc lllC T80/90/100°C Dc are available with flying leads on request. Devices in the ignition protection class "non-sparking" for protection type Ex nA llC T6, T5, T4 Gc are
available with flying leads on request.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical female connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
E 18.376.2.0/11.13
296
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
Protection types and applications (code): D, C the operating conditions and
̴ 35 applications described.
For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
̴ 35.5
M3
27.5
□ 18 M12x1
12.3
12
Ø 35
59.4
Ø 27
hex-
SW27
3
13.8
Elastomer profile
seal ring DIN3869
G1/2 A
Ø 29 h14
Ø 29.5
hex- 12
hex-SW27 SW27
2
20.5
8
10
Impact
protected metal
safety sleeve
SW25
hex-
SW27
E 18.376.2.0/11.13
The Impact protected metal safety sleeve is included. HYDAC electronic GmbH
A straight female connector is required for electrical Hauptstraße 27, D-66128 Saarbrücken
connection. e.g. female connector M12x1, 4 pole, Telephone +49 (0)6897 509-01
straight, with 3m shielded cable: ZBE 06S-03, Fax +49 (0)6897 509-1726
Part No. 6098243 E-mail: [email protected]
Internet: www.hydac.com
297
12
298
E 18.376.2.0/11.13
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 4700
with Flush Membrane
ATEX, IECEx, CSA
Flameproof Enclosure
Robust design 1)
Other mechanical connections on request
Very small temperature error 2)
Other output signals on request
Excellent EMC characteristics 3)
-20 °C with FPM seal , -40 °C on request
Excellent durability
299
Pin connections: Areas of application:
Approvals CCSAUS: Explosion Proof - Seal not required
Conduit (single cores) ATEX: Flame Proof
IECEx: Flame Proof
Certificate ATEX KEMA 10ATEX100X
CSA MC 224264
IECEx KEM 10.0053X
Applications / CCSAUS:
Protection types Class I Group A, B, C, D, T6; T5
Class II Group E, F, G
Class III
Type 4
Model code:
HDA 4 7 Z X – A – XXXX – XXX – D X – 000 (2m)
Mechanical process connection
Z = Flush membrane
Electrical connection
9 = 1/2-14 NPT Conduit
(male thread), single cores
Core HDA 47ZG-A G = 1/2-14 NPT Conduit
white Signal - (male thread),
flying leads
brown Signal +
green n.c. Signal
A = 4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor
yellow n.c.
Pressure ranges in bar
0040; 0060; 0100; 0250; 0400; 0600
12 Mechanical connection
G01 = G1/2 A, DIN 3852
G02 = G1/2 with additional front O-ring seal
Approval
D = CSA Explosion Proof – Seal not required
ATEX Flame Proof
IECEx Flame Proof
Type of measurement cell
S = Sealed Gauge (sealed to atmosphere) ≥ 40 bar
V = Vented Gauge (vented to atmosphere) ≤ 16 bar
Modification number
000 = Standard
Cable length in m
Standard = 2 m
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical female connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
E 18.374.2.0/11.13
300
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
Venting*
hex-
SW27
hex-
SW27
hex-
SW27
seal ring DIN3869
18.5 x 23.9 x1.5
O-ring 15x2 12
E 18.374.2.0/11.13
301
12
302
E 18.374.2.0/11.13
Electro-Mechanical
Flow Switch
HFS 2100
ATEX Encapsulation
for Oils / Viscous Fluids
Mechanical connection 4) 6)
Notes on installation: 1 = 1/4 "
2 = 3/8 "
The medium must not contain solid 3 = 1/2 "
particles! We recommend using 4 = 3/4 "
contamination strainers. 5 = 1 "
External magnetic fields can affect
Electrical connection
the switching contact. Ensure sufficient 1 = Flying leads
distance from magnetic fields (2m in length)
(e.g. from electric motors)!
Switching contacts 5)
1S = 1 N/O contact
Safety instructions: 2S = 2 N/O contacts
The circuits must not incorporate any 1W = 1 Change-over contact
effective inductance or capacitance. 2W = 2 Change-over contacts
The maximum ratings stipulated in Switching ranges in l/min 6)
the technical data must never be Oil 10 % -Size 1-
exceeded, not even for a short time. 00.5-01.6; 00.8-03.0; 02.0-07.0
To protect the switching contact, a Oil 10 % - Size 2-
fuse for the circuit must be provided 00.5-01.5; 0001-0004; 0002-0008; 0003-0010;
outside the hazardous area, unless 0005-0015; 0008-0024; 0010-0030; 0015-0045;
the switching unit is connected to an 0020-0060; 0030-0090; 0035-0110
intrinsically safe circuit.
Accuracy
Unless the device is connected to an 7 = ≤ 10.0 % FS
intrinsic safe circuit, special safety
precautions have to be implemented. Housing material
The device may be used in hazardous B = Brass (nickel-plated)
areas designated as category 2. S = Stainless steel
12
The device must not be used in areas Mechanical indicator
where there is a possibility that an 0 = Without indicator
electrostatic charge can be caused in 1 = With indicator
the plastic housing.
Modification number
The device must not be used in A00 = ATEX version for potentially explosive areas
machinery, systems or medical
apparatus where, in the event of
a malfunction, persons, animals
4)
Mechanical connection options depend on housing type
or equipment could be harmed or (see Dimensions).
5)
When the model with 2 switching contacts is selected, the second contact is mounted
damaged. on the side of the instrument, at 90° to the first contact.
6)
Other models available on request.
Note:
Special models on request.
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label
or the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors can be found
in the Accessories brochure.
E 18.393.1/11.13
304
Dimensions without indicator:
15
DN SW G L
0.5 .. 1.6 8 24 1/4“ 98 450
10 24 3/8“ 119 500
15 27 1/2“ *) 90 400
L
0.8 .. 3.0
15 27 1/2“ 90 400
2.0 .. 7.0
*) Standard
15
G 31.2
ca.: 39.2
SW
ca.: 50.2
12
OIL -Size 2- without indicator G
(approx.)
[l/min] [mm] [g]
DN SW G L T
0.5 .. 1.5 8 34 1/4" 152 10 1500
1 .. 4 15 34 1/2" 152 14 1425
20 34 3/4" 152 15 1340
25 40 1" *) 130 17 1160
L
2 .. 8
3 .. 10 15 34 1/2" 152 14 1425
20 34 3/4" 152 15 1340
5 .. 15 25 40 1" *) 130 17 1160
8 .. 24
10 .. 30
20 34 3/4" 152 15 1340
15 .. 45
T
E 18.393.1/11.13
305
Dimensions with indicator:
15
(approx.)
[l/min] [mm] [g]
90
DN SW G L
0.5 .. 1.6
0.8 .. 3.0 15 30 1/2" 90 570
15
33.5 G 1/2"
2.0 .. 7.0 65.5
69
ca.: 53.1
30
30
47
T
(approx.)
12 [l/min] [mm] [g]
DN SW G L T
0.5 .. 1.5 8 34 1/4" 152 10 1590
L
T
3 .. 10 15 34 1/2" 152 14 1515 70.5 G
20 34 3/4" 152 15 1430
5 .. 15 25 40 1" *) 130 17 1250
8 .. 24
10 .. 30
20 34 3/4" 152 15 1430 ca.: 63.1
15 .. 45
25 40 1" *) 130 17 1250 40
20 .. 60
30 .. 90
25 40 1" 130 17 1250
40
35 .. 110
57
*) Standard
applications described.
For applications and operating conditions not described, please contact the relevant Tel.: 0 68 97 / 509-01
technical department. Fax: 0 68 97 / 509-1726
Subject to technical modifications. Internet: www.hydac.com
E-mail: [email protected]
306
Electro-Mechanical
Flow Switch
HFS 2500
ATEX Encapsulation
for Water or Water-based Media
Note:
Special models on request.
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
E 18.394.1/11.13
308
Dimensions without indicator:
Water 5 % accuracy
0.2 .. 4.0
0.6 .. 5.0
1/4" 8
0.5 .. 8.0 27 30 53 3/8" 10 14 131 850
1/2" 15
1 .. 14
1 .. 28
2 .. 40 27 30 1/2" 15 14 146
53 900
4 .. 55 32 35 3/4" 20 16 174
1 .. 70
34 40 63 3/4" 20 18 152 1400
8 .. 90
40 40 63 1" 25 19 156 1100
5 .. 110
10 .. 150 50 50 73 1 1/4" 32 21 200 2750
35 .. 220 50 50 73 1 1/4" 32 21 200 3000
35 .. 250 60 60 78 1 1/2" 40 24 200 3800
*)
Standard
E 18.394.1/11.13
309
Dimensions with indicator:
Water 5 % accuracy
0.2 .. 4.0
0.6 .. 5.0 1/4" 8
3/8" 10
0.5 .. 8.0 27 30 53 14 131 940
1/2" 15
1 .. 14
1 .. 28
2 .. 40 27 30 1/2" 15 14 146
53 990
4 .. 55 32 35 3/4" 20 16 174
1 .. 70
34 40 63 3/4" 20 18 152 1490
8 .. 90
40 40 63 1" 25 19 156 1190
5 .. 110
10 .. 150 50 50 73 1 1/4" 32 21 200 2840
35 .. 220 50 50 73 1 1/4" 32 21 200 3090
35 .. 250 60 60 78 1 1/2" 40 24 200 3890
*)
Standard
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to the operating conditions and HYDAC electronic GmbH
E 18.394.1/11.13
310
E 18.394.1/11.13
311
12
Display and Monitoring Units
13 The universal display unit HDA 5500 provides the means of visualising
and further processing the signals from our sensors.
The unit is designed for front panel mounting with a standard 92 x 45 mm
cut-out.
312
13
Description:
The digital display units in the
HDA 5500 series are microprocessor-
controlled display and monitoring
instruments designed for control
panel installation.
Different versions are available with
a maximum of 3 analogue inputs, an
analogue output (4 .. 20 mA or
0 .. 10V) and up to 4 relay outputs.
The analogue input signals are
displayed according to the settings
selected by the user.
Each of the relay outputs can be
allocated to each of the sensor inputs
or to the differential between input
1 and 2.
A PT 100 temperature probe can be
connected directly to the instrument.
There is also an option for frequency
measurement using the HDS 1000
(HYDAC rpm probe), for example
to measure the speed of rotating
components.
Depending on the model, it is also
possible to connect SMART sensors
(condition monitoring sensors).
SMART sensors are a generation
of sensors from HYDAC which can
transmit several different measured
values.
Special features:
Digital display of analogue signals Up to 4 relay switching outputs
Clear 4-digit 7-segment RS 232 interface
LED display Voltage supply
Up to 3 analogue inputs 12 .. 32 V DC or
(4 .. 20 mA, 0 .. 10 V or 0 .. 5 V) 85 .. 265 V AC 50 / 60 Hz
Accuracy ≤ ± 0.5 % Option for PT100 sensor input or
Differential measurement possible frequency input
Analogue output
(4 .. 20 mA or 0 .. 10 V)
E 18.062.3/11.13
313
Input models: Technical data:
Display range
13 Display 4-digit 7-segment LED display, red,
height of digits 14.2 mm
Analogue transm.
3 LEDs for active sensor, 4 LEDs for switch points
or HDA 5500-0-... Display range - 999 .. 9999 (user-adjustable)
Analogue seq.
Display units with bar, kg/cm², MPa, psi, °C, °F, mA, V, Hz, kN,
background lighting m, mm, inch, l, l/min, gal, gal/min, 1/min, %, t
Input data
Analogue transm. Analogue signal input(s)
Analogue transm. HDA 5500-1-... Measuring range(s) select: 4 .. 20 mA, 0 .. 5 V, 0 .. 10 V or
(up to 3 analogue inputs) 4 .. 20 mA sequential (Modification 006)
Analogue transm.
Accuracy ≤ ± 0.5 % at 25 °C
PT 100 input
Measuring range - 25 .. 100 °C
Analogue transm.
Accuracy ≤ ± 0.5 % at 25 °C
HDA 5500-2-... Frequency/counter input
Frequency transm.
Signal threshold 0 .. 0.6 V = LOW, 3 .. 24 V = HIGH
Frequency range 15 Hz to 24 kHz
Output data
Analogue transm. Analoge output 4 .. 20 mA, load resistance ≤ 400 Ω or
HDA 5500-3-... 0 .. 10 V load resistance ≥ 2 kΩ
Pt100 temp. transm. Accuracy ≤ ± 0.5 % at 25 °C
Rise time 70 ms
Switching outputs
Type 2 or 4 relays each with separate common supply
Switching voltage 0.1 .. 250 V AC
Switching current 9 mA .. 2 A
Output models: Switching capacity 400 VA, 50 W
(for inductive load, use varistors)
Life expectancy of switch contacts ≥ 20 million cycles at minimum load
HDA 5500-X-0-... ≥ 1 million cycles at maximum load
Reaction time approx. 20 ms
Analogue (with switching delay = 0 ms)
Setting range of switch points 1.5 .. 100 % of the pre-set display range
Relay output 1
Setting range of the switching 0.5 .. 99 % of the pre-set display range
hystereses (switch-back points)
Relay output 2
HDA 5500-X-1-... Interface
Serial interface Baud rate 19200 Bauds; 8 data bits;
Analogue
RS 232 2 stop bits; no parity;
no handshake
Environmental conditions
Relay output 1
Nominal temperature range 0 .. +50 °C
Relay output 2
HDA 5500-X-2-... Operating temperature range 0 .. +50 °C
Relay output 3
Storage temperature range - 40 .. +80 °C
Relay output 4
Analogue
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Other data
Housing control panel housing 96 x 48 x 109 mm;
Connection terminals: control panel cut-out 92 (+0.8) x 45 (+0.6) mm;
Supply voltage: front panel thickness 1.25 .. 15 mm;
plug-in terminal block 2 pole, RM 5.08 maximum installation depth 121 mm
(cross section max. 2.5 mm²) Supply voltage 12 .. 32 V DC or
Inputs / outputs: 85 .. 265 V AC, 50 / 60 Hz
plug-in terminal block 11 pole, RM 3.5 Power consumption 15 VA at 85 .. 230 V AC – fuse protection 1 AT
(cross section max. 1.5 mm²)
Supply of the meas. transmitter 12 V DC ± 1 %; max. 20 mA / analogue input
Relay:
Residual ripple of supply ≤ 5%
plug-in terminal block 5 pole, RM 5.08
(cross section max. 2.5 mm²) voltage
Weight approx. 320 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage,
override and short circuit protection are provided.
E 18.062.3/11.13
314
Model code: Notes:
The information in this brochure relates
HDA 5 5 0 0 – X – X – XX – 00X
to the operating conditions and 13
applications described.
Inputs For applications and operating
0 = One analogue input conditions not described, please contact
1 = Three analogue inputs the relevant technical department.
2 = One analogue input + frequency Subject to technical modifications.
input / counter function
3 = One analogue input + PT 100 input
Outputs
0 = 1 analogue output
1 = 1 analogue output + 2 relay outputs
2 = 1 analogue output + 4 relay outputs
Supply voltage
AC = 85 .. 265 V AC
DC = 12 .. 32 V DC
Modification
000 = Standard
006 = Model with sequential analogue input for HLB 1300 and CS 1000
(only possible on input model "0" and output model "2")
Dimensions:
thickness of
control panel
panel cut-out
E 18.062.3/11.13
315
Service Instruments
13 Our service instruments have been specially developed for use in servicing,
maintenance and the laboratory, as well as for commissioning.
All commonly available sensors (e.g. pressure, temperature, flow rate,
14 condition monitoring, ...) with a very wide range of output signals can be
connected to these instruments.
316
13
HMG 500
Description:
The HMG 500 is a portable measuring
instrument for simple measuring tasks
in fluid technology such as hydraulics,
pneumatics, lubrication, process,
refrigeration and air conditioning.
Up to two sensors with the HYDAC
Sensor Interface (HSI) can be
connected to the HMG 500 to measure
pressure, temperature or flow rate
(except for SMART sensors). The HMG
500 automatically recognises these
sensors and takes all of the necessary
basic settings from each sensor.
The measurement values and the
corresponding physical unit are
displayed on an easy-to-read LCD
display.
In addition, the HMG 500 offers a wealth
of other advantages over mechanical
pressure gauges, for example, for
measuring pressure on machines and
systems.
The user benefits from a technologically
high level of measuring accuracy and
dynamics.
The HMG 500 measures values at a
very high sampling rate. It can therefore
record and display pressure peaks in
the maximum value memory or rapid
pressure discharges in the minimum
value memory, for example.
Furthermore, differential measurements
can be carried out using two sensors
of a similar type, to calculate pressure
drops or temperature differentials. Special features:
To further extend the application range, Portable 2-channel data recorder Zeroing (taring) of the individual
HMG 500 has a function for setting Simple and user-friendly key operation measurement channels
mechanical pressure and temperature
Large LCD display including Display of the actual measured values
switches precisely and reliably.
battery status indication Display of the differential (channel A
Compact, simple and versatile - the
2 sensor inputs, minus channel B)
HMG 500 is an invaluable tool for all
those involved in maintenance, automatic sensor recognition Minimum or maxmum value indication,
commissioning and service. Measuring range and unit of with reset function
measurement of the sensors Setting device for mechanical
connected to it are recognised pressure and temperature switches
automatically
E 18.063.2/11.13
317
Technical data: Ordering details:
Measurement 2 analogue inputs
13 inputs for HYDAC measurement transmitters
with HSI interface HMG 500 - 000
(except for SMART sensors**) Items supplied
14 HMG 500
Accuracy* ≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.
Operating manual D/E/F
Functions Automatic recognition of measuring
range and unit of measurement 9 V battery
Taring of the measuring channels
Display of the actual meas. value HMG 500-Set 01
Min./max. indication Items supplied
Reset of the min./max. values HMG 500
Measured values differential Operating manual D/E/F
channel A - channel B
9 V battery
Display of units, selectable
Setting device for mechanical pressure HDA 4748-H-0600-000
and temperature switches ZBE 30-02, sensor cable M12x1, 2 m
Display 4-digit 7 segment LCD display Connection adapter G1/4 female to Minimess 16X2
with battery status indication; Case for HMG 500 / 510
2 measurement values incl. unit displayed
simultaneously
Measurement unit Selectable
(depending on the Pressure: bar, psi, MPa HMG 500-Set 02
sensors Temperature: °C, K, °F Items supplied
connected Flow rate: l/min, gallon/min HMG 500
to HMG) (1 US gallon = 3.7853 l) Operating manual D/E/F
Sampling rate 0.1 ms 9 V battery
Resolution 12 bit 2 off HDA 4748-H-0600-000
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4 2 off ZBE 30-02, sensor cable M12x1, 2 m
Safety EN 61010
2 off connection adapter G1/4 female to Minimess 16X2
Protection class IP 54
Case for HMG 500 / 510
Voltage 9 V battery
supply Oper. time: approx. 10 h (with 2 sensors)
Euro plug power supply (230 V AC)
(available as an accessory)
Accessories:
Environmental Operating temp.: +5 .. +60 °C
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical and
conditions Storage temp.: -40 .. +70 °C
mechanical connection adapters, power supply, etc. can
Rel. humidity: 0 .. 70 % be found in the Accessories brochure.
Weight 410 g
Examples of main accessories:
Note:
* FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range Pressure transmitter
** SMART sensors (Condition Monitoring Sensors) are HDA 4000 with HSI interface
a generation of sensors from HYDAC which can provide Pressure ranges: -1 .. 9 bar, 0 .. 16 bar, 0 .. 60 bar,
a variety of different measurement values. 0 .. 100 bar, 0 .. 250 bar, 0 .. 400 bar, 0 .. 600 bar
Temperature transmitter
Dimensions: ETS 4000 with HSI interface
Measuring range: -25 .. 100 °C
Flow rate transmitter
EVS 3000 with HSI interface
Measuring ranges: 1.2 .. 20 l/min, 6 .. 60 l/min,
15 .. 300 l/min, 40 .. 600 l/min
Sensor simulator
SSH 1000, ideal for training purposes
Electrical connection adapter
UVM 3000, for mechanical pressure and
temperature switches
Hydraulic adapters
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to the operating
E 18.063.2/11.13
318
13
HMG 510
Description:
The HMG 510 is a hand-held instrument
for simple measurement tasks on
hydraulic and pneumatic systems in
mobile and industrial applications.
Compact and simple to use, the
HMG 510 is an ideal tool for all those
involved in maintenance, commissioning
and service.
Up to two sensors with the HYDAC
Sensor Interface (HSI) can be
connected to the HMG 510.
Sensors are available to measure
pressure, temperature and flow rate as
well as sensors for condition monitoring
(also known as SMART sensors).
Some examples of SMART sensors are
the HYDACLAB® Oil Condition Sensor,
the AS 1000 AquaSensor and the
CS 1000 Contamination Sensor.
The HMG 510 automatically recognises
these sensors and takes all the
necessary basic settings from each
sensor.
The measurement values and the
corresponding physical unit are
displayed on an easy-to-read LCD
display.
In addition to this, the HMG 510 enables
measured values which have been
saved in the SMART sensors to be
uploaded to a PC.
With the aid of the HYDAC PC software
"CMWIN", the measurement data stored
in the SMART sensors can be displayed Special features:
on a PC screen in the form of a graph, Portable 2-channel data recorder Zeroing (taring) of the individual
then analysed, edited and saved. measurement channels
The HMG has a standard integrated Simple and user-friendly key operation
USB port to enable this data transfer. Large LCD display including Display of the actual measured values
To further extend the application range, battery status indication Display of the differential
the HMG 510 has a function for setting 2 sensor inputs, automatic sensor (channel A minus channel B)
mechanical pressure and temperature recognition Min. or max. value indication,
switches precisely and reliably. Specially designed to display with reset function
measured values from condition Setting device for mechanical
monitoring sensors (SMART sensors) pressure and temperature switches
Measuring range and unit of USB port
E 18.066.2/11.13
319
Technical data: Ordering details:
Measurement 2 analogue inputs
13 inputs for HYDAC measurement transmitters
with HSI interface and SMART sensors HMG 510 - 000
Accuracy* ≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.
14
Functions Automatic recognition of measuring
range and unit of measurement Items supplied
Taring of the measuring channels Case for HMG 500 / 510
Display of the actual measured value HMG 510
Min./max. indication Operating manual D/E/F
Reset of the min./max. values
9 V battery
Measured values differential
channel A - channel B USB cable
Display of units, selectable Y adapter blue (for HLB 1300)
Setting device for mechanical pressure Y adapter yellow (for CS 1000)
and temperature switches ZBE 30-02, sensor cable M12x1, 2m
Communication bridge to a connected PC
Software CD with "CMWIN"
Display 4-digit 7 segment LCD display
with battery status indication;
2 measured values incl. unit displayed
simultaneously Accessories:
Measurement unit Selectable for Appropriate accessories, such as electrical and
(depending on the Pressure: bar, psi, MPa mechanical connection adapters, power supply, etc. can
sensors Temperature: °C, K, °F be found in the Accessories brochure.
connected) Flow rate: l/min, gallon/min Examples of main accessories:
(1 US gallon = 3.7853 l) Pressure transmitter
Permanently pre-set on SMART sensors HDA 4000 with HSI interface
Sampling rate 0.1 ms Pressure ranges: -1 .. 9 bar, 0 .. 16 bar, 0 .. 60 bar,
Resolution 12 bit 0 .. 100 bar, 0 .. 250 bar, 0 .. 400 bar, 0 .. 600 bar
mark EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4 Temperature transmitter
ETS 4000 with HSI interface
Safety EN 61010
Measuring range: -25 .. 100 °C
Protection class IP 54
Flow rate transmitter
Voltage 9 V battery EVS 3000 with HSI interface
supply Operating time: approx. 10 h Measuring ranges: 1.2 .. 20 l/min, 6 .. 60 l/min,
(with 2 sensors)** 15 .. 300 l/min, 40 .. 600 l/min
Euro plug power supply (230 V AC)
(available as an accessory) Sensor simulator
SSH 1000, ideal for training purposes
Environmental Operating temperature: +5 .. +60 °C
conditions Storage temperature: -40 .. +70 °C Electrical connection adapter
Rel. humidity: 0 .. 70 % UVM 3000, for mechanical pressure or temperature
switches
Weight 410 g
Hydraulic adapters
* FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
** Not applicable to SMART sensors, as they require
an external voltage.
Dimensions:
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to the operating
conditions and applications described.
For applications and operating conditions not described,
please contact the relevant technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.066.2/11.13
320
13
HMG 3010
Description:
The HMG 3010 is an impressive, top
performance portable measuring and
data recording device.
Automated setting procedures, a simple,
self-explanatory operator guide and
many comprehensive functions ensure
the operator is able to carry out a wide
range of measuring tasks within a very
short time and to work in a way which is
both time-saving and cost-effective.
The HMG 3010 thus quickly becomes a
reliable and helpful tool in the working
environment of service, maintenance,
development, test rig technology, quality
assurance or commissioning of systems
and machines.
The HMG 3010 is designed primarily
to record pressure, temperature and
flow rate values which are the standard
variables in hydraulics and pneumatics.
For this purpose, special sensors are
available, with which the variable,
the measurement range and unit
are automatically detected by the
HMG 3010. The device also offers
measurement inputs for standard
sensors with current and voltage
signals. In addition to the analogue
inputs, the HMG 3010 also has two
digital inputs (e.g. for frequency or rpm
measurements).
The ability to connect the HMG 3010
to a CAN bus and thus to display
messages from the CAN bus completes Special features:
the range of applications. Simple, user-friendly operation Very large data memory for
Due to the wide range of functions and Practical, robust design archiving measurement curves
its simple handling, the HMG 3010 is Large, full-graphics colour display Various measurement modes:
just as appropriate for users who take – Normal measuring
measurements only occasionally as it is Quick and independent basic setting
– Fast curve recording
for professionals for whom measuring of the device through the use of
– Long term measuring
and documentation are routine. automatic sensor recognition
4 independent triggers,
The update capability of the Up to 10 sensors can be connected
can be logically linked
HMG 3010 via the integral USB port simultaneously
ensures that the user can benefit from PC connection
Up to 32 measurement channels can
future upgrades of the device software. – USB
be displayed at a time
– RS 232
Measuring rates up to 0.1 ms
Convenient visualisation, archiving
Extended voltage measurement
E 18.399.1/11.13
321
Function: Measured values, curves or texts are
Clear and graphical selection menus visualized on a full-graphics colour
guide the operator very simply to all display in different selectable formats
13 and display forms.
the device functions available. A
navigation pad on the keypad ensures
14 rapid operation.
The HMG 3010 can monitor
signals from up to ten sensors
simultaneously. For this there are
5 robust standard input sockets. By
using Y adapters, the number of inputs
can be doubled individually to make a
total of between 6 and 10. The data memory for recording
Up to 8 sensors can be connected to 4 curves or logs can hold up to 500,000
of these input sockets: measured values. At least 100 such
- 8 sensors (e.g. for pressure, full-length data records can be stored
temperature, and flow rate) with in an additional archive memory.
the special digital HSI interface For specific, event-driven curves
(HYDAC Sensor Interface); or logs, the HMG 3010 has four Numerous useful and easy-to-use
this means the basic device independent triggers, which can be auxiliary functions are available,
settings (measured variable, range, linked together logically. e.g. zoom, ruler tool, differential value
and unit of measurement) are It is also possible to determine graph creation and individual scaling,
undertaken automatically differential values between different which are particularly for use when
- 8 standard analogue sensors input signals from sensors. Particularly analysing the recorded measurement
with current and voltage signals when measuring flow rate by means curves.
- 4 Condition Monitoring sensors*) of differential pressure measurement
(SMART sensors); again, the across a measuring orifice, the
basic device settings are carried out accuracy can be significantly improved
automatically by using a stored calibration curve.
To generate such calibration curves,
Frequency measurements, counter the HMG 3010 has an easy-to-use
functions, or triggers for data logging handheld recording function.
can be implemented via the fifth input
socket with 2 digital inputs. User-specific device settings can
be stored and re-loaded at any time
For extended voltage measurement, as required. This means that repeat
the HMG 3010 offers the possibility measurements can be carried out on
of recording signals of a machine again and again using the
0 .. 50 V on two inputs and a signal same device settings.
of -10 .. +10 V on one input (e.g.
proportional valve control).
The connection to a CAN bus in The HMG 3010 communicates with a
conjunction with the CAN adapter PC via the built-in USB port or RS 232
ZBE 3010 makes it possible to record port.
CAN messages (e.g. motor speed,
motor oil pressure) in combination
with measured data from the hydraulic
system.
HYDAC CAN bus sensors connected
directly to the CAN adapter can be
parameterized using the HMG 3010
(node ID and baud rate)
All input channels can
operate simultaneously at a
measurement rate of 0.5 ms (1.0 ms
for SMART sensors). To record highly
dynamic processes, 2 analogue inputs
are capable of recording measured
values of 0.1 ms.
The most impressive function of the
HMG 3010 is its ability to record
dynamic processes "online", i.e. in
real-time, as a measurement curve
and to render them as graphs in the
field.
E 18.399.1/11.13
322
HMGWIN 3000: Some examples of the numerous Overlay of curves, for example to
useful additional functions: document the wear of a machine (new
The PC software HMGWIN 3000 is also
supplied with the device. This software Transfer and archiving of condition/current condition)
13
is a convenient and simple package measurements recorded using the
for analysing and archiving curves and HMG 3010
logs which have been recorded using Display of the measurements in graph 14
the HMG 3010, or for exporting the data form or as a table
for integration into other PC programs
if required. It is also possible to operate
the HMG 3010 directly from the
computer, to undertake basic settings,
and to start measurements online and
display them directly on the PC screen
as measurement curve progressions.
CMWIN: Using mathematical operations
The HYDAC software CMWIN is also (calculation functions, filter functions)
supplied with the device. new curves can be added.
This software enables you to Zoom function: Snap-shot function: comparable to the
communicate directly with SMART Using the mouse, a frame is drawn function of a digital camera, a picture
sensors *) connected to the HMG 3010 around an interesting section of a can be taken immediately of any graph
from your PC. measurement curve, which is then and saved as a jpg file.
enlarged and displayed. A professional measurement
Both programs can be run on report can be produced at the click
PCs with Windows Vista / XP / 2000 of a mouse: HMGWIN 3000 has an
and Windows 7 operating systems. automatic layout function.
Starting with a table of contents, all
recorded data, descriptions, and
graphics and/or tables are combined
into a professional report and saved as
a pdf file.
Online function:
Starting, recording, and online
display of measurements
Fig.: Zoomed section of measurement curve
(similar to the function of an
oscilloscope)
Accurate measurement of the curves
using the ruler tool (time values,
amplitude values, and differentials)
*) SMART sensors
E 18.399.1/11.13
323
Technical data: Order details:
Meas. inputs 4 input sockets (channels A-H) for HMG 3010 - 000 - X
13 connecting up to 8 analogue
sensors or up to 4 SMART
sensors.
14 1 input socket with 2 digital Operating manual and documentation
inputs (channels I-J) and one D = German
voltage input of -10 V to E = English
+ 10 V (shown on channel H) F = French
Sensors are connected using
standard M12x1 male connectors
(5 pole)
Channels A, B, E, F, G Items supplied
(Accuracy) HSI (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) HMG 3010
4 .. 20 mA (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) Power supply for 90 .. 230 V AC
0 .. 20 mA (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) Operating manual
0 .. 4.5 V (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.)
0 .. 5 V (≤ ± 0.2 % FS max.) CD-ROM containing USB drivers, HMGWIN 3000 and
0 .. 10 V (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) CMWIN software
0.5 .. 4.5 V (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) USB connection cable
0.5 .. 5.5 V (≤ ± 0.2 % FS max.)
1 .. 5 V (≤ ± 0.2 % FS max.)
1 .. 6 V (≤ ± 0.2 % FS max.)
Channels C and D HSI (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) Accessories:
(Accuracy) 4 .. 20 mA (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.)
0 .. 20 mA (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) CAN adapter, required for CAN bus
0 .. 4.5 V (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) operation ( to be ordered separately)
0 .. 5 V (≤ ± 1.0 % FS max.) ZBE 3010 CAN adapter for HMG 3010
0 .. 10 V (≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.) Material No. 921238
0 .. 50 V (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.)
0.5 .. 4.5 V (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.)
0.5 .. 5.5 V (≤ ± 1.0 % FS max.)
1 .. 5 V (≤ ± 1.0 % FS max.)
1 .. 6 V (≤ ± 1.0 % FS max.)
Channel H HSI (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.)
(Accuracy) 4 .. 20 mA (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.)
Additional accessories, such as electrical and
0 .. 20 mA (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.)
0 .. 4.5 V (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) mechanical connection adapters, power adapters, etc.
0 .. 5 V (≤ ± 0.2 % FS max.) can be found in the "Accessories - Service
0 .. 10 V (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) devices" catalogue section
0.5 .. 4.5 V (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.)
0.5 .. 5.5 V (≤ ± 0.2 % FS max.)
1 .. 5 V (≤ ± 0.2 % FS max.)
1 .. 6 V (≤ ± 0.2 % FS max.) Dimensions:
-10 .. +10 V (≤ ± 0.5 % FS max.)
Channels I and J Frequency range: 1 .. 30 000 Hz
(Accuracy) (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.)
Switching / switch-back threshold: 2 V / 1 V
Max. input voltage: 50 V
Differential channels A - B
C-D
Difference channel for flow rate-
measurement orifice (shown on channel B)
Measuring rate 0.1 ms, max. 2 analogue input channels
(dependent on 0.2 ms, max. 4 analogue input channels
the number of 0.5 ms, all 10 input channels shown with protective cover open
active channels) 1.0 ms, for SMART sensors
resolution 12 bit
Memory At least. 100 measurement curves,
each with up to 500,000 measured values
Display 3.5" colour display
Interfaces 1 USB, 1 serial port
mark EN 61000-1/2/3/4 Note:
Safety EN 61010 The information in this brochure relates to the operating
Protection class IP 40 conditions and applications described.
Ambient Operating temp.: 0 .. +50 °C For applications or operating conditions not described,
conditions Storage temp.: -20 .. +60 °C please contact the relevant technical department.
Rel. humidity: 0 .. 70 % Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.399.1/11.13
Weight 1100 g
HYDAC ELECTrONIC GMBH
Note: Hauptstraße 27, D-66128 Saarbrücken
FS (Full Scale) = relative to the full measuring range Telephone +49 (0)6897 509-01, Fax +49 (0)6897 509-1726
E-mail: [email protected], Internet: www.hydac.com
324
13
Electronic 14
Pressure Transmitter
with HSI Sensor Recognition
HDA 4748-H
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage, override and
short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to the complete measuring range,
B.F.S.L.= Best Fit Straight Line
1)
1000 bar only with mechanical connection G 1/2 DIN 3852 and vice versa
2)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
325
Model code: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
13
HDA 4 7 4 8 – H – XXXX – 000 the operating conditions and applications
described.
Mechanical connection For applications or operating conditions
2 = G1/2 DIN 3852 (male) not described, please contact the relevant
14 (only for "1000 bar" press. range) technical department.
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male) Subject to technical modifications.
Electrical connection
8 = Male, M12x1, 5 pole
(connector not supplied)
Signal
H = HSI (automatic sensor recognition)
Pressure ranges in bar
0009; 0016; 0060; 0100; 0250; 0400; 0600 (only in conjunction with mech. conn. "4")
1000 (only in conjunction with mech. connection "2")
Modification number
000 = Standard
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label
or the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
Dimensions:
elastomer
elastomer
profile gasket
profile gasket
DIN 3869
DIN 3869
optional
O-ring
20.35 x 1.78
E 18.332.2/11.13
326
13
Electronic 14
Temperature Transmitter
with HSI Sensor Recognition
ETS 4148-H
327
Model code: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
13
ETS 4 1 4 8 – H – 006 – 000 the operating conditions and applications
described.
Mechanical connection For applications or operating conditions
4 = G1/4 A DIN 3852 (male) not described, please contact the relevant
14 technical department.
Electrical connection Subject to technical modifications.
8 = Male, M12x1, 5 pole
(connector not supplied)
Signal
H = HSI (automatic sensor recognition)
Probe length
006 = 6 mm
Modification number
000 = Standard
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
Dimensions:
hex. SW27
elastomer
profile gasket
DIN 3869
E 18.333.1.1/11.13
328
13
Electronic 14
329
Model code: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
13
EVS 3 1 X 8 – H – XXXX – 000 the operating conditions and applications
described.
Housing material For applications or operating conditions
0 = Aluminium not described, please contact the relevant
14 1 = Stainless steel technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
Electrical connection
8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole
(connector not supplied)
Signal
H = HSI (Automatic Sensor Recognition)
Measuring range
0020 = 1.2 .. 20 l/min
0060 = 6.0 .. 60 l/min
0300 = 15.0 .. 300 l/min
0600 = 40.0 .. 600 l/min
Modification number
000 = Standard
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found in the
Accessories brochure.
Dimensions:
330
E 18.334.2/11.13
331
14
13
Condition Monitoring Products
Condition monitoring is the process of logging and interpreting condition
information from machines, systems and their components, with the aim
of implementing predictive maintenance programs based on the condition
of the system.
The operating data of the machine or system is recorded continuously
using the HYDAC sensor system. The recorded data is then analysed and
interpreted. Finally this compressed condition information can be trans-
mitted to the operator, enabling him to monitor and control the machine or
system using a variety of communication channels.
15
Condition monitoring products from HYDAC ELECTRONIC GMBH:
Page
CMU 1000, Condition Monitoring Unit 333
CSI-B-2, Interface Module 337
HLB 1300, Oil condition sensor 339
AS 1000, AquaSensor 341
AS 3000, AquaSensor 343
AS 3000 IO-Link , AquaSensor 345
EY 1356, Contamination switch 347
E 180.000.2 /11.13
332
Condition Monitoring Unit
CMU 1000
15
Description:
The CMU1000 is an electronic
evaluation unit designed for permanent
online condition monitoring of machines
and systems.
In order to achieve this, the device must
be supplied with relevant data which is
recorded by the sensors connected to it.
This recorded data (processed or
unprocessed) can be transferred by the
CMU 1000 via different ports or as an
analogue value to other devices and/or
monitoring levels.
The CMU 1000 processes the
application program stored in it
continuously and cyclically like a PLC.
The user creates this program simply
and conveniently on a PC using the CM
Editor developed for this purpose and
then uploads it to the CMU 1000.
The CM Editor is part of the HYDAC PC
software CMWIN Version V03 or higher
(supplied) and it provides the various
tools and functions in accordance with
IEC 61131 for designing, integrating and
testing the user program using "drag
and drop" operations.
For status indication and for displaying
messages and values on the device
itself, there is a back-lit LCD display and
three different coloured LEDs.
The CMU 1000 is operated and data
is input on site using a built-in keypad
within the menu structure of the device.
The CMU 1000 is designed for use in
machines in both the stationary and
mobile sectors.
It is possible to connect easily to
higher-level control, monitoring and bus
Special features:
systems using the built-in interfaces or in 8 input channels for HSI or SMART 2-line LCD display (2 x 16 characters)
combination with an additional coupling sensors to display measured data and status
module. 8 input channels for analogue sensors and/or error messages
4 input channels for digital signals 3 user-programmable LEDs in different
colours, for status indication
2 output channels for analogue signals
(red, yellow, green)
4 relay switching outputs with
Simple operation using navigation
change-over contacts
pad
USB slave port for PC connection
Creation of customised application
E 18.357.2/11.13
USB master port for storing measured program using the PC software
data on a standard USB memory stick CMWIN supplied
Ethernet interface
RS 232 interface
333
CM Editor:
The CM Editor is part of the HYDAC PC software CMWIN, Version 03 or higher, and provides a wide variety of tools and
functions for designing, integrating and testing the application program.
An application program consists of many individual functions which can be linked together. During subsequent operation, this
user program is processed as for a PLC, cyclically.
The program is created according to the IEC 61131 (the standard for PLC programming).
15
E 18.357.2/11.13
334
Technical data:
Supply Interfaces
Input voltage 18.0 .. 35.0 V DC Keypad - 4 arrow keys (up, down,
Current consumption max. 1.5 A (3.5 A when right, left)
CSI-F-10 connected) - OK key
- ESC key
Reverse pol. protect.: -30 V
Isolation voltage +40 V Display - Two-line LCD display
(back-lit) (2 x 16 characters)
Connection of sensors - Additional indication of status
Up to 8 sensors with HSI functionality or information via
up to 8 SMART sensors1) and in addition up to 8 analogue 3 different coloured LEDs
sensors and is possible 15
up to 4 digital sensors
USB Mass Storage - USB 1.1 / USB 2.0 full speed
4 x digital / 2 x digital + 2 x frequency /
Device2) port for connecting
3 x digital + 1 x frequency
a mass storage device
Analogue inputs (memory stick)
Channel I and J 4 .. 20 mA (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) - Female connection type "A".
(Accuracy) 0 .. 20 mA (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) Ethernet, - RJ 45 8/8 Ethernet interface
0.5 .. 4.5 V (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) supported protocols - HTTP Server
0 .. 10 V (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.)
- TCP/IP
Channel K and L 4 .. 20 mA (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.)
(Accuracy) 0 .. 20 mA (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) Serial Interface 0 - Implementing an RS 232 or
0.5 .. 4.5 V (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) (UART 0) an HSI master interface
0 .. 50 V (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) - Change-over user-programmable
-10 .. +10 V (≤ ± 0.2 % FS max.) L only! - Connection via plug-in terminals
- No handshake lines
Channel M and N 4 .. 20 mA (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.)
(Accuracy) 0 .. 20 mA (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) HSI Master Cascading the CMU
0.5 .. 4.5 V (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) USB Device - USB 1.1 / USB 2.0 full speed
Channel O and P 4 .. 20 mA (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) port for connecting
(Accuracy) 0 .. 20 mA (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) a PC / Notebook to
0.5 .. 4.5 V (≤ ± 0.1 % FS max.) configure the CMU
-10 .. +10 V (≤ ± 0.2 % FS max.) P only! - Female connection type "B".
Digital inputs CAN Bus Interface Can be integrated as an option
Quantity 4, of which 2 are for frequency Cycle time
measurement (Channel Q and R)
Independently determined at start of program
Trigger threshold approx. 2 V Display of actual cycle time is possible in the CM Editor
Dynamics 30 kHz
Operating and environmental conditions
Measurement channels
Operating temperature -20 .. +70 °C
Quantity 32 - A measurement channel can be a
value of a connected sensor Storage temperature -30 .. +80 °C
(also a subchannel of a SMART Relative humidity 0 .. 70 %,
sensor) or a value derived non-condensing
(calculated) from sensor data. Dimensions and weight
Analogue outputs Dimensions approx. 212 x 106 x 36 mm
Quantity 2
Weight approx. 600 g
Type individually selectable,
Technical standards
current (4 .. 20 mA) or
voltage (0 .. 10 V) EMC EN 61000-6-1 / 2 / 3 / 4
Digital outputs Safety EN 61010
Quantity 4 Protection class IP 40
Type: Relay output, change-over contact
Note:
Switching capacity 30V DC / 1 A 1)
SMART sensors (Condition Monitoring Sensors) are
Calculation unit a generation of sensors from HYDAC, which can
Analogue value 12 bit A/D converter provide a variety of different measured values.
recording
2)
Recorded data from the CMU can be transferred
to a memory stick via this interface.
The USB Host supports mass storage devices
exclusively.
E 18.357.2/11.13
335
Block circuit diagram: Note:
The information in this brochure relates
to the operating conditions and
applications described. For applications
SRAM CAN transceiver
and operating conditions not described,
Processor optional please contact the relevant technical
Flash department.
16 Bit Subject to technical modifications.
Ethernet Keypad
(HTTP server / (4 x arrows / OK / ESC)
TCP/IP)
3 x LED
(user-programmable)
8 x HSI-IN
8 x Analogue-IN 2 x Analogue-OUT
4 x Digital-IN 4 x Digital-OUT
Model code:
CMU 1000 – 000 – X
Modification number
000 = Standard
Operating manual and documentation
D = German
E = English
F = French
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the technical
amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as sensor lines for the electrical connection can be found in
the Accessories brochure.
Dimensions:
E 18.357.2/11.13
336
Condition Monitoring
Interface Module
CSI-B-2
15
337
Model code: Terminal assignment:
Terminal strip –X1
CSI – B – 2 – 000
Pin Signal
Modification number 1 RS 485 (-)
000 = Standard
2 RS 485 (+)
3 3 – 4 open: HSI to RS 232
4 3 – 4 closed: HSI to RS 485
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the technical 5 RxD RS 232
amendment details supplied with the instrument. (connected to Pin 3 SUB-D 9 pole)
6 TxD RS 232
(connected to Pin 2 SUB-D 9 pole)
15 Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as sensor lines for the electrical connection can be found 7 0V
in the Accessories brochure. (connected to Pin 5 SUB-D 9 pole)
8 +UB (18 .. 35 V DC) Module supply
Note:
The information in this brochure relates
to the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications and operating
conditions not described, please
contact the relevant technical
department.
Subject to technical modifications
E 18.359.2/11.13
338
Oil Condition Sensor
HYDACLAB
HLB 1300
15
2)
The accuracy achievable when measuring the relative change in dielectric
constant is dependent on the application, the type of oil and the individual
calibration of the sensor. Detailed information on this is available on request.
339
Pin connections:
Model code:
HLB 1 3 0 8 – 1 C – 000 – F 1 M12x1
Variables
3 = 3 variables
- Relative change in dielectric constant (DK) 4 3
- Saturation level 5
- Temperature
Mechanical connection 1 2
0 = G3/4 A DIN 3852
Electrical connection
8 = Male M12x1, 5-pole (connector not supplied) Pin
15
Type of signal, output 1 1 +UB
1 = Switching output / N/C
2 Signal 1
Type of signal, output 2 3 ^
C = 4 .. 20 mA, 3 conductor
4 Signal 2
Modification number
000 = Standard (cannot be adjusted) 5 HSI* Reset (PLC)
Seal material (parts in contact with the fluid) * HSI = HYDAC Sensor Interface
F = FPM seal (HYDAC's own communication
interface)
Connection material (in contact with fluid) Signal 1: PNP switching output
1 = Stainless steel Signal 2: Sequential analogue output
(4 .. 20 mA)
Note:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label Display and read-out
or the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument. options:
Accessories:
HDA 5500-0-2-Zc-006
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, can be found
Digital Display Unit; the HDA 5500
in the Electrical Accessories brochure. displays the sequential analogue output
of the HYDACLAB and provides the
user with 4 programmable switching
outputs.
Dimensions: HDA 5500-0-2-AC-006(CM1k)
Order no.: 909925
HDA 5500-0-2-DC-006(CM1k)
Order no.: 909926
HMG 510
Portable 2-channel data recorder,
male electr. conn.
SMART sensors
Order no.: 909889
HMG 3010
Portable data recorder with full graphics
colour display for indicating, displaying
and editing measured values
Order no.: 920930
hex-SW27
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.371.2/11.13
340
AquaSensor
AS 1000
15
341
Model code: Pin connections:
AS 1 X 0 8 – X – 000 M12x1
Medium
0 = Mineral oils 4 3
1 = Phosphate ester, e.g. Skydrol 5
Mechanical connection 1 2
0 = G3/8 A DIN 3852
Electrical connection
8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole
(connector not supplied)
Pin AS 1X08-C AS 1X08-2
15 Signal technology
1 +UB +UB
C = Output 1 Pin 2 saturation level (4 .. 20 mA)
Output 2 Pin 4 temperature (4 .. 20 mA) 2 Saturation level SP 1
2 = 2 switching outputs 4 .. 20 mA
3 0V 0V
Modification number
4 Temperature SP 2
000 = Standard
4 .. 20 mA
Notice:
5 HSI* HSI*
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label
* HSI = HYDAC Sensor Interface (HYDAC's
or the technical amendment details supplied with the instruments. own communication interface)
Note:
E 18.321.2/11.13
342
AquaSensor
AS 3000
15
operations.
343
Model code: Pin connections:
AS 3 X 0 8 – 5 – 000 M12x1
Medium
0 = Mineral oils 4 3
1 = Phosphate ester, e.g. Skydrol 5
Mechanical connection 1 2
0 = G3/8 A DIN 3852
Electrical connection
8 = Male M12x1, 5 pole
(connector not supplied)
Pin AS 3X08-5
15 Signal technology
1 +UB
5 = 2 switch outputs and 1 analogue output
2 Analogue
Modification number 3 0V
000 = Standard
4 SP 1
Note: 5 SP 2
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label
or the technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, mechanical connection
adaptors, etc. can be found in the Accessories brochure.
Dimensions:
hex-SW27
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.605.0/11.13
344
AquaSensor
AS 3000
with IO-Link Interface
15
345
Setting options: IO-Link-specific data:
All terms and symbols used for setting the Baud rate 38.4 kBaud *
AS 3000 as well as the menu structure Cycle time 2.5 ms
comply with the specifications in the Process data width 16 Bit
VDMA Standard. Frame type 2.2
Specification V1.1
Setting ranges for the switch *C
onnection with unshielded standard sensor line possible
outputs: up to a max. line length of 20 m.
Download the IO Device Description (IODD) from:
Measuring Lower limit of Upper limit of http://www.hydac.com/de-en/service/downloads-software-on-request/
range RP SP
Model code:
0 .. 100 % 1% 100 %
AS 3 X 0 6 – L – 000
15
Measuring Minimum Increment* Medium
range difference betw. 0 = Mineral oils
RP and SP 1 = Phosphate ester, e.g. Skydrol
0 .. 100 1% 0.2 %
Mechanical connection
-25 .. 100 °C 0.1 °C
0 = G3/8 A DIN 3852
* All ranges given in the table are Electrical connection
adjustable by the increments shown. 6 = Male M12x1, 4-pole
SP = switching point (connector not supplied)
RP = switch-back point Output
L = IO Link interface
Additional functions: Modification number
Switching direction of the switching 000 = Standard
outputs adjustable (N/C or N/O function)
Switch-on and switch-off delay
adjustable from 0.00 .. 99.99 seconds Notes:
On instruments with a different modification number, please read the label or the
Analogue output signal selectable technical amendment details supplied with the instrument.
4 .. 20 mA or 0 .. 10 V
Accessories:
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors, mechanical connection
Pin connections: adaptors, etc. can be found in the Accessories brochure.
M12x1, 4 pole
L+
IO-Link
1 C/Q
2
3
4
Dimensions:
L- Standard IO
I/Q
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
E 18.605.1.0/11.13
346
Electronic
Contamination Switch
EY-1356
15
Functional principle /
diagram:
The permanent solenoid at the
measuring surface of the contamination Electronics for
display
switch attracts the ferromagnetic particles
from the passing oil. The increased
accumulation of particles forms an
electrical bridge between the permanent
solenoid and the adjacent metal contact.
The resulting switching signal can, for Contamination
instance, activate a warning function or switch
switch off the system.
E 18.602.1/11.13
347
Order details: Pin connections:
Electrical connection Mechanical connection Part number in accordance with EN 175301-803
Integrated male connector M14x1.5 3252533 Without connector
according to M18x1.5 3305023
EN175301-803/ ISO4400
M22x1.5 3731848
M26x1.5 3731849
M33x2 3252555
Strand DEUTSCH male M14x1.5 3731852
connector M18x1.5 3731853
DT04 2 pole Pin
15 M22x1.5 3731854
M26x1.5 3731855 1 +UB
Pin
Protective sleeve
1 +UB
Female 2 -UB
connector
gasket GDM3-16 Reverse polarity permitted
(NBR)
Hirschmann
Switching example:
Seal ring
DIN 3869 NBR
Seal ring
DIN 3869 NBR
Dim. 14 18 22 26 33
A M14x1.5 M18x1.5 M22x1.5 M26x1.5 M33x2 Other types
B 12 12 12 12 12 of connec-
tion are
C 4 4 4 4 4.5 available on
D 3 3 3 3 4 request
ØE 19 23.9 27 31.4 39.2
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
HYDAC ELECTrONIC GMBH
E 18.602.1/11.13
applications described.
For applications and operating conditions Hauptstraße 27, D-66128 Saarbrücken
Telephone +49 (0)6897 509-01
not described, please contact the relevant Fax +49 (0)6897 509-1726
technical department. E-mail: [email protected]
Subject to technical modifications. Internet: www.hydac.com
348
E 18.602.1/11.13
349
15
OEM Products for Large Volume Production
Areas of application for our OEM products for large volume production
range from mobile and stationary industrial hydraulics, to pneumatics,
machine building, automotive and mobile technology through to mining, oil
depots, marine and the off-shore industry.
Our sensors are available in a variety of electrical output signals,
connector and fluid port connection options. This versatility, combined with
certification to ATEX, CSA and IECEx or , ensures an almost limitless
range of applications for our products.
Temperature transmitters
• HTT 8000 (minimum order 500 pieces) 375
350
Electronic Pressure
Transmitter
HDA 8700
Weight ~ 55 g
Note: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage,
override, short-circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
B.F.S.L.= Best Fit Straight Line
1)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
2)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No 61010-1
351
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
Male connection Male connection Male connection described.
DIN 72585 Metri-Pack Deutsch DT04 For applications or operating conditions
3 pole series 150 3 pole not described, please contact the relevant
3 pole technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
Male connection
EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
16 3 pole
hex.-SW27
orifice
hex.-SW27
hex.-SW27
orifice
orifice
Order details:
E 18.347.2/11.13
352
Electronic Pressure
Transmitter
HDA 8400
353
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
Male connection Male connection Male connection described.
DIN 72585 Metri-Pack Deutsch DT04 For applications or operating conditions
3 pole series 150 3 pole not described, please contact the relevant
3 pole technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
Male connection
EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
16 3 pole
hex.-SW27
orifice
hex.-SW27
hex.-SW27
orifice
orifice
Order details:
E 18.348.2/11.13
354
Electronic
Pressure Transmitter
HDA 8700
for Applications with
Increased Functional Safety
Functional Safety
PL d
SIL 2
(Minimum order quantity 500 units)
SIL 2
Note.: Reverse polarity protection of the supply voltage, excess voltage,
override and short circuit protection are provided.
FS (Full Scale) = relative to complete measuring range
B.F.S.L. = Best Fit Straight Line
1)
Other seal materials on request
2)
-25°C with FPM seal, -40°C on request
355
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
Ø 25.9 ±0.30 For applications or operating conditions
Male connection not described, please contact the relevant
Junior Timer 2 pole technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
max. 48+0.3
29.5
2.5
4.1
12
hex.-SW27
G1/4 A
16 orifice Ø 0.5
Ø 18.9 -0.2
Ø 23.5 -0.1
Ø 29.4 -0.1
2.5
5.1
10 ±0.13
hex.-SW27 9/16-18UNF2A
orifice Ø 0.5 Ø 19 ±0.30
Ø 23.5 -0.1
2.5
5.1
9.14 ±0.13
Ø 23.5 -0.1
Order details:
E 18.347.1.0/11.13
356
Electronic Pressure
Transmitter
HDA 7400
hex.-SW27
16
hex.-SW27
elastomer elastomer
profile seal ring profile seal ring
DIN3869 DIN3869
E 18.349.2/11.13
358
Electronic Pressure
Transmitter
HDA 9300
359
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
Electr. conn. male the operating conditions and applications
Deutsch DT 04 described.
3 pole For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
Ø 26.6 +0.1
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
3.5
16
16
18.5
10
36 Max.
2
12
hex.-SW27 G1/4 A
Ø 18.9 -0.2
Ø 29.5 -0.05
10 ±0.13
2.3
17 +0.2
9/16-18UNF2A
hex.-SW27
hex.-SW27 1/4-18NPT Ø 19 ±0.3
O-ring
Ø 29.5 -0.05 11.89 x 1.98 Ø 29.5 -0.05
9.14 ±0.13
2.3
7/16-20UNF2A
hex.-SW27
Ø 14.3 ±0.13
O-ring 8.92 x 1.83
Ø 29.5 -0.05
Order details:
E 18.349.1.0/11.13
360
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 810
Male connection
DIN EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
16 3 pole
hex-SW27
orifice
hex-SW27
hex-SW27
orifice
orifice
Order details:
E 18.350.2/11.13
362
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 710
363
Dimensions (examples): Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
cable screen and core ends For applications or operating conditions
are twisted & tinned not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
hex-SW27
16
hex-SW27
elastomer elastomer
profile seal ring profile seal ring
DIN3869 DIN3869
Order details:
E 18.351.2/11.13
364
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 410
365
Dimensions (examples): Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications or operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
16
cable gland PG 9
Order details:
E 18.352.2/11.13
366
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 4400
ATEX, CSA, IECEx
Flameproof Enclosure
367
Pin connections: Areas of application:
Pin connections are configured according Approvals CCSAUS: Explosion Proof - Seal not required
to customer specification. ATEX: Flame Proof
IECEx: Flame Proof
Conduit (single cores) Certificate ATEX KEMA 10ATEX100X
CSA MC 224264
IECEx KEM 10.0053X
Applications / CCSAUS:
Protection types Class I Group A, B, C, D, T6, T5
Class II Group E, F, G
Class III
Type 4
IECEx:
Ex d I Mb
Ex d IIC T6, T5 Gb
Ex tb IIIC T110 .. 130 °C Db
16 Order details:
The electronic pressure switch EDS 4400 with triple approval has been specially
developed for OEM customers and is available for minimum order quantities of
50 units per type. For exact specification, please contact the Sales Department of
HYDAC ELECTRONIC.
Dimensions:
Venting Venting
hex-
hex-SW27 SW27
hex-SW27
hex-SW27
elastomer
profile seal ring
DIN3869
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
Hauptstraße 27, D-66128 Saarbrücken *) optional, depending on gauge type "Sealed Gauge" / "Vented Gauge"
Telephone +49 (0)6897 509-01
Fax +49 (0)6897 509-1726
E-mail: [email protected]
Internet: www.hydac.com
368
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 4400
ATEX Intrinsically Safe
Instruments for other Protection types and applications are available upon request.
16 Please contact our technical sales department for more information.
Order details:
The electronic pressure switch EDS 4400 in ATEX version has been specially developed
Safety instructions: for OEM customers and is available for minimum order quantities of 50 pieces per type.
For exact specification, please contact the Sales Department of HYDAC ELECTRONIC.
The switching output
draws the switching energy
Accessories:
from the power supply to the
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors can be found in the Accessories
pressure switch. No additional brochure.
energy is introduced into
the electrical circuit from the
switching output.
Dual Zener barriers specified
and approved in the technical
data must be used to connect
the pressure switch. These have
a reverse polarity diode to
decouple the signal.
The signal path may only be Dimensions:
passively loaded.
Ensure that measured
fluids in contact with the
pressure switch are
compatible with the materials
used.
profile seal ring
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications or operating conditions hex-SW27
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
elastomer
profile seal ring
E 18.353.2/11.13
370
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 4300
ATEX Intrinsically Safe
Instruments for other Protection types and applications are available on request.
16 Please contact our technical sales department for more information.
Order details:
The electronic pressure switch EDS 4300 in ATEX version has been specially developed
Safety instructions: for OEM customers and is available for minimum order quantities of 50 pieces per type.
For exact specification, please contact the Sales Department of HYDAC ELECTRONIC.
The switching output
Accessories:
draws the switching energy
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors can be found
from the power supply to the
in the Accessories brochure.
pressure switch. No additional
energy is introduced into the
electrical circuit from the
switching output.
Dual Zener barriers specified
and approved in the technical
data must be used to connect
the pressure switch. These
have a reverse polarity diode to
decouple the signal.
The signal path may only be Dimensions:
passively loaded.
Ensure that measured
fluids in contact with the
pressure switch are
compatible with the materials
used.
profile seal ring
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications or operating conditions hex-SW27
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
elastomer
profile seal ring
E 18.354.2/11.13
372
Electronic
Pressure Switch
EDS 4100
ATEX Intrinsically Safe
Instruments for other protection types and applications are available on request.
16 Please contact our technical sales department for more information.
Order details:
The electronic pressure switch EDS 4100 in ATEX version has been specially developed
Safety instructions: for OEM customers and is available for minimum order quantities of 50 pieces per type.
For exact specification, please contact the Sales Department of HYDAC ELECTRONIC.
The switching output
draws the switching energy
Accessories:
from the power supply to the
Appropriate accessories, such as electrical connectors can be found
pressure switch. No additional in the Accessories brochure.
energy is introduced into the
electrical circuit through the
switching output.
Dual Zener barriers specified
and approved in the technical
data must be used to connect
the pressure switch. These
have a reverse polarity diode to
decouple the signal.
The signal path may only be Dimensions:
passively loaded.
Ensure that the measured
fluids in contact with the
pressure switch are
compatible with the materials
used.
profile
seal ring
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
For applications or operating conditions hex-SW27
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
elastomer
profile seal ring
E 18.355.2/11.13
374
Electronic
Temperature Transmitter
HTT 8000
2)
Other mechanical connections on request
3)
-25 °C with FPM seal, -40 °C on request
4)
Environmental conditions according to 1.4.2 UL 61010-1; C22.2 No 61010-1
375
Dimensions: Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
Male connection Male connection Male connection For applications and operating conditions
DIN 72585 Metri-Pack series 150 DT04 3 pole not described, please contact the relevant
3 pole 3 pole
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
Male connection
16 EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
3 pole + PE
Male connection
M12x1 - 4 pole
hex-SW27
Order details:
E 18.389.1/11.13
376
Electronic
Temperature Switch
HTS 8000
Male connection
16 EN175301-803 (DIN 43650)
3 pole + PE
Male connection
M12x1 - 4 pole
hex-SW27
Ø 6.7
Order details:
E 18.390.1/11.13
378
Electronic
Position Switch
HLS 100
for Applications with Increased
Functional Safety
Functional Safety
PL d
SIL 2
(Minimum order quantity 100 units)
Identification:
white point to
IO-test
16
Switching ranges:
Switching range:
Switching distance:
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and
applications described.
Lateral offset: For applications and operating conditions
not described, please contact the relevant
technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.391.1/11.13
380
Special Products
Position Sensors
and Position Switches
The position sensors and switches have been developed for short distance monitoring
and can be used on the one hand for monitoring valve settings and
on the other as part of a control. Based on different measuring techniques, HYDAC
provides different variants for a diverse range of applications.
Special features:
Pressure resistant to 400 bar
Inductive measurement (LVDT)
Various stroke sizes
Output: 2 switching outputs with change-over function
Electrical connection: M12x1 (4 pole)
Special features:
Pressure resistant to 400 bar
Inductive measurement (LVDT)
Different measuring ranges (up to max. ±7 mm)
Output: Analogue 4 .. 20 mA
Electrical connection: M12x1 (4 pole)
Functional Safety
Position switch HLS 200 PL d
with increased functional safety
The position switch HLS 200 is used for reliable detection of valve centre positions.
They are used both in mobile and in stationary applications.
Special features:
PL d certification
Measuring technique: IR light barriers
Output: 2 switching outputs with change-over function
Electrical connection: M12x1 (4 pole); Deutsch DT 04 (4 pole)
been especially developed for volume applications described. HYDAC ELECTrONIC GMBH
production customers. For applications and operating conditions Hauptstraße 27, D-66128 Saarbrücken
Telephone +49 (0)6897 509-01
For a precise specification, please not described, please contact the relevant Fax +49 (0)6897 509-1726
contact the Sales Department of HYDAC technical department. E-mail: [email protected]
ELECTRONIC. Subject to technical modifications. Internet: www.hydac.com
381
Accessories
Electrical Accessories Page
- for electrical connection type "4" (Binder, Series 714 M18) 383
- for electrical connection type "5" (EN175301-803 (DIN 43650) / 383
ISO 4400)
- for electrical connection type "6" (M12x1, 4 pole) 384
- for electrical connection type "7" (DIN 43561) 385
- for electrical connection type "8" (M12x1, 5 pole) 385
- for electrical connection type "P" (M12x1, 8 pole) 387
17
Accessories for distance and position sensors 397
- Magnets for HLT 1000, HLT 2000, HNT 1000 397
- Electrical accessories HLT 2000 399
382
Electrical
Accessories
Female Connectors for Sensors
ZBE 03
Female connector
Binder Series 714 M18
17
4 pole, right-angle
Cable diameter: 6.5 .. 8 mm
Part No.: 609480
383
With electrical connection type "6":
(Male M12x1, 4 pole)
ZBE 06
Female connector M12x1
4 pole, right-angle
Cable diameter: 2.5 .. 6.5 mm
Part No.: 6006788
ZBE 06-02
Female connector M12x1
4 pole, right-angle
with 2 m cable
Part No.: 6006790
ZBE 06-05
Female connector M12x1
4 pole, right-angle
with 5 m cable
Part No.: 6006789
Colour code:
Pin 1: brown
Pin 2: white
Pin 3: blue
Pin 4: black
ZBE 06S-03
Female connector M12x1
17 4-pole, straight
with 3 m cable, shielded
Part No.: 6098243
ZBE 06S-05
Female connector M12x1
4-pole, straight
with 5 m cable, shielded
Part No.: 6143284
ZBE 06S-05
Female connector M12x1
4 pole, right-angle
with 5 m cable, shielded
Part No.: 6044891
Colour code:
Pin 1: brown
Pin 2: white
Pin 3: blue
Pin 4: black
E 18.362.2/11.13
384
With electrical connection type "7":
(Male DIN 43651)
ZBE 10
Female connector DIN 43651
6 pole + PE, right-angle
Cable diameter: 7 .. 9 mm
Part No.: 654527
ZBE 08-02 17
Female connector M12x1
5 pole, right-angle
with 2 m cable
Part No.: 6006792
ZBE 08-05
Female connector M12x1
5 pole, right-angle
with 5 m cable
Part No.: 6006791
Colour code:
Pin 1: brown
Pin 2: white
Pin 3: blue
Pin 4: black
Pin 5: grey
E 18.362.2/11.13
385
ZBE 08S-02
Female connector M12x1
5 pole, right-angle
with 2 m cable, shielded
Part No.: 6019455
ZBE 08S-05
Female connector M12x1
5 pole, right-angle
with 5 m cable, shielded
Part No.: 6019456
ZBE 08S-10
Female connector M12x1
5 pole, right-angle
with 10 m cable, shielded
Part No.: 6023102
Colour code:
Pin 1: brown
Pin 2: white
Pin 3: blue
Pin 4: black
Pin 5: grey
ZBE 30-02
Connection cable M12x1
plug/socket
5 pole, 2 m
Part No.: 6040851 or
ZBE 30-05
Connection cable M12x1
plug/socket male
type label
female
5 pole, 5 m M12x1 5 pole M12x1 5 pole
17
E 18.362.2/11.13
386
With electrical connection type "P":
(Male M12x1, 8 pole)
ZBE 0P
Female connector M12x1
8 pole, right-angle
Cable diameter: 4 .. 8 mm
Part No.: 6055444
ZBE 0P-02
Female connector M12x1
8 pole, right-angle
with 2 m cable
Part No.: 6052697
ZBE 0P-05
Female connector M12x1
8 pole, right-angle
with 5 m cable
Part No.: 6052698
Colour code:
Pin 1: white
Pin 2: brown
Pin 3: green
Pin 4: yellow
Pin 5: grey
Pin 6: pink
Pin 7: blue
Pin 8: red
17
E 18.362.2/11.13
387
17
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
E 18.362.2/11.13
388
Mechanical
Accessories
ZBM 02
Adapter female thread G1/4 –
male thread G1/2 A,
DIN 3852
Part No.: 257277 hex. SW27
O-ring
20.35x1.78
-NBR
17
ZBM 13
Adapter female thread G1/4 -
male thread G1/4 A,
with orifice 0.5 mm
Part No.: 906968 hex. SW27
elastomer
seal ring
DIN3869
orifice
ZBM 14
Adapter female thread G1/4 -
male thread G1/4 (rotating)
Part No.: 907818 hex. SW19
elastomer
seal ring
DIN3869
E 18.363.2/11.13
389
Mounting accessories, device-specific
EDS 8000, HDA 8000; EDS 810
ZBM 8000
Clamp for wall-mounting
- screw-type fitting -
hex. socket cap
(Material of lower section: screw. ISO4762
ZBM 8100
Clamp for wall-mounting
- weld-type fitting -
(Material of welding bridge: hex. socket cap
screw. ISO4762
QSTE340TM, zinc coating
EN 12329 FE/ZN8/B;
Material of lower section:
TPE Santoprene 10187;
Material of top section:
Steel strip DIN 95381-1.4571)
Part No.: 3546757
17
E 18.363.2/11.13
390
Mounting accessories, device-specific
EDS 3000, ETS 3000, AS 3000, ENS 3000 and HNS 3000
ZBM 3000
Clamp for wall-mounting
- screw-type fitting -
(Material of lower section:
TPE Santoprene 10187;
Material of top section:
Steel strip DIN 95381-1.4571)
hex. socket cap
screw. ISO4762
Part No.: 3184630
ZBM 3100
Clamp for wall-mounting
- weld-type fitting -
(Material of welding bridge:
QSTE340TM, zinc coating
EN 12329 FE/ZN8/B;
Material of lower section: hex. socket cap
TPE Santoprene 10187; screw. ISO4762
17
ZBM 3200
Splash guard
(Material:
Elastollan S60 A15 SPF 000)
Part No.: 3201919
E 18.363.2/11.13
391
Mounting accessories, device-specific
EDS 300, ETS 300
ZBM 300
Clamp for wall-mounting
- screw-type fitting -
(Material polypropylene)
Part No.: 906385
ZBM 310
Clamp for wall-mounting
- weld-type fitting -
(Material polypropylene,
aluminium AlSi12, steel)
Part No.: 6011511
17
392
Mounting accessories, device-specific
EDS 1700, ETS 1700
Vibration mounts
Part No.: 257492
17
E 18.363.2/11.13
393
Tank mounting sleeve , device-specific
ETS 3000 (100 mm)
Protective sleeve for
tank-mounting
(Material CuZn39Pb3 - DIN 1763, hex-SW27
electro-nickel-plated)
Part No.: 909640
17 seal ring Cu
DIN7603-A 30x36
SW36
ZBM 20
Straight male stud coupling to
ISO 8434 compression nut (SW36)
ISO8434-1-N-L22-St
SW32
E 18.363.2/11.13
394
Mounting block, device-specific
HLB 1300
ZBM 21 (Flow)
Mounting block for HLB 1300
for flow rates > 2 l/min
Part No.: 3244260
17
Connection accessories, device-specific
AS 1000, AS 3000
ZBM 22
Mounting block for AquaSensor
AS 1000 and AS 3000
Part No.: 3248511
E 18.363.2/11.13
395
17
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
E 18.363.2/11.13
396
Accessories
Sensors for Distance
and Position
ZBL Mr22
Position magnet for HLT 1000 and
HLT 2100
Part No.: 6084453
17
ZBL Mr33
Position magnet for HLT 1000 and
HLT 2100
Part No.: 6084207 E 18.603.0/11.13
397
ZBL MV63
Position magnet for
HLT 1000, HLT 2100 and
HLT 2500-L2
Part No.: 6084454
ZBL MS35-39
Measuring slide for
HLT 2500-L2
Part No.: 6105654
17
ZBL MU38-20
Position magnet for
HLT 1000, HLT 2100 and
HLT 2500-L2
Part No.: 6084455
E 18.603.0/11.13
398
ZBL MF38-18
Position magnet for
HLT 2500-F1
Part No.: 6084456
ZBL MF55-20
Position magnet for
HLT 2500-F1
Part No.: 6084457
399
17
Note:
The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and HYDAC electronic GmbH
E 18.603.0/11.13
400
Accessories for Service
Instruments
Aluminium case
for HMG 30X0 and accessories
Part No.: 6042959
17
ZBE 31
Car charger for HMG 30X0
Part No.: 909739
ZBE 34
Adapter for HMG 30X0 for connecting
HYDAC transmitters
(4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor)
Male M12x1 to
Binder series 714 M18
(electrical connection type "4")
Part No.: 3236597
ZBE 35
Adapter for HMG 30X0 for connecting
HYDAC transmitters
(4 .. 20 mA, 2 conductor)
Male M12x1 to
E 18.364.2/11.13
Male EN175301-803
(DIN 43650)
(electrical connection type "5")
Part No.: 3236601
401
ZBE 36
Adapter for HMG 30X0 for connecting
an AquaSensor AS 1000
Part No.: 909737
ZBE 38
Y adapter (black) for HMG 30X0 to
double the number of input sockets
Part No.: 3224436
ZBE 41
Y adapter (yellow) for HMG 30X0
for connecting a
ContaminationSensor CS 1000
Part No.: 910000
ZBE 3010
CAN adapter for HMG 3010
for connecting a CAN-Bus
Part No.: 921238
17 Connection cable
for HMG 30X0 - PC (USB),
Spare Part
Part No.: 6040585
402
UVM 30X0
Module for HMG 30X0 for connecting
different input signals
Part No.: 909752
Plastic case
for HMG 500/510 and accessories
Part No.: 6043006
Connection cable
for HMG 510 - PC (USB),
Spare Part
Part No.: 6049553
17
Note:
SSH 1000 The information in this brochure relates to
the operating conditions and applications
Sensor simulator to simulate described.
2 HSI sensors, ideal for training For applications or operating conditions
purposes not described, please contact the relevant
Part No.: 909414 technical department.
Subject to technical modifications.
E 18.364.2/11.13
403
404
E 180.000.2/11.13
Notes:
Notes:
E 180.000.2/11.13
405
406
E 180.000.2/11.13
Notes:
ÖSTERREICH HYDAC-Büro München MEXICO KOREA
rOK
MEX
(Slovenia, Croatia, Bosnia- Herzegovina, Danziger Str. 21 HYDAC International SA de CV HYDAC Duwon Co. 08
A
Serbia and Montenegro, Macedonia) D-82194 Gröbenzell Pirul, 212 4th floor Wonwook Bldg.
HYDAC Hydraulik Ges. m.b.H. Tel.: 0 81 42 / 6 52 77-0 54090 Los Reyes Ixtacala 768-12 Bangbae, Seocho
Industriestr. 3 Fax: 0 81 42 / 6 52 77-22 Tlalnepantla (Edo. de Mexico) rOK-Seoul 137-069
A-4066 Pasching HYDAC-Büro Nürnberg MEXICO Tel.: (0082) 2/591 09 31
Tel.: (0043) 72 29 / 6 18 11-0 Bauhofstraße 4 Tel.: (0052) 555 / 565 85 11 Fax: (0082) 2/591 09 32
Fax: (0043) 72 29 / 6 18 11-35 D-90571 Schwaig Fax: (0052) 555 / 390 23 34 E-mail: [email protected]
E-mail: [email protected] Tel.: 09 11 / 24 46 43-0 NORGE ROMANIA
rOM
AUSTRALIA Fax: 09 11 / 24 46 43-4260 HYDAC AS HYDAC SRL
N
AUS
DK
HYDAC A/S
Altona North. Havretoften 5 Tel.: (0047) 64 85 86 00 Tel.: (0040) 244 57 57 78
AUS-Vic. 3025 DK-5550 Langeskov Fax: (0047) 64 85 86 01 Fax: (0040) 244 57 57 79
postal address: Tel.: (0045) 702 702 99 E-mail: [email protected] E-Mail: [email protected]
P.O. Box 224, Altona North. Fax: (0045) 63 13 25 40 NETHERLANDS SVERIGE
AUS-Vic. 3025
NL
E-Mail: [email protected] HYDAC B.V. HYDAC Fluidteknik AB
S
Tel.: (0061) 3 / 92 72 89 00 Vossenbeemd 109 Domnarvsgatan 29
Fax: (0061) 3 / 98 360 80 70 ESPAÑA
HYDAC TECHNOLOGY SL NL-5705 CL Helmond S-16308 Spånga
E
E-mail: [email protected] Tel.: (0031) 492 / 597470 Tel.: (0046) 8 / 4452970
Capcir 5, P.O. Box 162
BELGIQUE E-08211 Castellar del Valles Fax: (0031) 492 / 597480 Fax: (0046) 8 / 4452990
HYDAC sprl E-mail: [email protected] Internet: www.hydac.se
B
NZ
HYDAC Ltd. SINGAPORE
SGP
Tel.: (0032) 12 260 400 EGYPT
Unit 14, 13 Highbrook Drive Hydac Technology Pte Ltd.
ET
Fax: (0032) 12 260 409 Yasser Fahmy Hydraulic Eng.
65-66-68 Saudi Building, Kobba East Tamaki 2A Second Chin Bee Road
BULGARIA P.O. Box 6550 Sawah 11813 NZ-Auckland Singapore 618781
BG
HYDAC EOOD ET-Cairo Tel.: (0064) 9271 4120 Tel.: (0065) 6741 7458
Business Center Iskar Yug Tel.: (0020) 2 / 45 20 192, 45 30 922 Fax: (0064) 9271 4124 Fax: (0065) 6741 0434
München-Str. 14 45 30 923, 45 01 970 PORTUGAL SLOVAKIA
BG-1528 Sofia
SK
Fax: (0020) 2 /45 30 638 Gustavo Cudell Lda. HYDAC, s.r.o.
P
Tel.: (00359) 2 970 6000, E-Mail: [email protected] Rua Eng. Ferreira Dias, 954 Schmidtova 14
(00359) 2 970 6060 P-4149-008 Porto SK-03601 Martin
Fax: (00359) 2 970 6075 FRANCE
HYDAC S.à.r.l. Tel.: (00351) 22 / 6158000 Tel.: (00421)- 43-4135893, 4237394
F
SL
Fax: (0033) 3 87 85 90 81 Rua Prof. Henrique de Barros 5 B HYDAC d.o.o. Slovenia
BY 220035 Minsk Belarus E-Mail (siège): 2685-339 Prior Velho Zagrebska c. 20
Tel.: (00375) 17 209 01 32-33 [email protected] P-1801 Lisboa Codex SL-2000 Maribor
Fax: (00375) 17 209 01 35 E-Mail (agence Nord-Est): Tel.: (00351) 219 429 900 Tel.: (00386) 2 /460 15 20
E-Mail: [email protected] [email protected] Fax: (00351) 219 413 500 Fax: (00386) 2 /460 15 22
Internet: www.hydac.com.by Internet: www.movicontrol.pt E-mail: [email protected]
AGENCE DE PARIS:
BRASIL Tel.: (0033) 1 60 13 97 26 E-Mail: [email protected] THAILAND
Br
T
Rua Fukutaro Yida, 225
PL
AGENCE DE LYON: (Lithuania, Latvia) 169/4, 169/5 Moo 1
CEP 09852-060 HYDAC Sp. z o.o. Rangsit-Nakhonnayok Rd.
Br-Sao Bernardo do Campo-SP Tel.: (0033) 4 78 87 83 02
E-mail: [email protected] ul. Reymonta 17 Lampakkud, Thanyaburi
Tel. (0055) 11/43 93 66 00 PL-43-190 Mikoł ˙ ow Patumthanee 12130
Fax: (0055) 11/43 93 66 17 AGENCE DE BORDEAUX: Tel.: (0048) 32 226 26 55, 32 326 29 00 Tel.: (0066) 2577 2999 (30 lines)
E-mail: [email protected] Tel.: (0033) 5 57 54 25 20 Fax: (0048) 32 226 40 42, 32 326 29 01 Fax: (0066) 2577 2700
CANADA E-Mail: [email protected] Email: [email protected]
CDN
AGENCE DE CHATEAUNEUF
HYDAC Corporation LES MARTIGUES: CHINA TURKEY
PrC
14 Federal Road
Tr
Tel.: (0033) 4 42 49 61 35 HYDAC Technology (Shanghai) Ltd. HYDAC Ltd. Sti.
Welland, Ontario 28 Zhongpin Lu Namık Kemal Mahallesi
L3B 3P2 FINLAND
Shanghai Minhang Economic & Adile Nasit Bulvarı
FI
TW
Allmendstr. 11 HYDAC International HYDAC Technology Ltd.
CH-6312 Steinhausen/Zug GREAT BRITAIN
GB
HYDAC TECHNOLOGY Limited ul. 4-ya Magistralnaya, 5, office 31 No. 18 Shude 1st Lane, South District
Tel.: (0041) 41 / 747 03 20 rUS 123007 Moscow TW-Taichung City/Taiwan 40242
Fax: (0041) 41 / 747 03 29 De Havilland Way, Windrush Park
GB-Withney, Oxfordshire Tel.: (007) 495 980 80 01-03 Tel.: (00886) 4 / 2260 22 78
E-mail: [email protected] Fax: (007) 495 980 70 20 Fax: (00886) 4 / 2260 23 52
Internet: www.hydac.ch OX29 0YG
Tel.: (0044) 1993 866366 E-Mail: [email protected] E-Mail: [email protected]
HYDAC S.A. Fax: (0044) 1993 866365 Internet: www.hydac.com.ru UKRAINE
UKr
Zona Industriale 3, Via Sceresa Internet: www.hydac.co.uk Technical Office St. Petersburg HYDAC Ukraine
CH-6805 Mezzovico E-Mail: [email protected] Obvodnyi chanel emb., 138, Büro Kiev
Tel.: (0041) 91 / 935 57 00 blok 101, of 401 ul. Novokonstantinovskaya, 9,
Fax: (0041) 91 / 935 57 01 GREECE
Gr
Delta-P Technologies Ltd. rUS 190020 St. Petersburg Korpus 13, 2 Etage
E-mail: [email protected] Tel.: (007) 812 495 94 62 UA 04080 Kiev
Internet: www.hydac.ch 2, Grevenon Str.
Gr-11855 Athens Fax: (007) 812 495 94 63 Tel.: (0038) 044 495 33 96
ČESKÁ REPUBLIKA Tel.: (0030) 210 3410181 E-Mail: [email protected] (0038) 044 495 33 97
CZ
HYDAC S.R.O. Fax: (0030) 210 3410183 Technical Office Novokuznetsk Fax: (0038) 044 495 33 98
Kanadska 794 E-Mail: [email protected] ul. Nevskogo, 1, office 300 E-mail: [email protected]
CZ-39111 Planá nad Luznici rUS 654079 Novokuznetsk USA
USA
HYDAC-Büro Südost Tsim Sha Tsui Kowloon, Hong Kong HYDAC TECHNOLOGY Executive office, Room 7,
Wiesestr. 189 Tel: (00852) - 23 - 69 35 68 ARGENTINA S.R.L. 364, Cong Hoa Street,
D-07551 Gera Fax: (00852) - 23 - 69 35 67 Av. Belgrano 2729 Tan Binh District
Tel.: 03 65 / 73 97-320 (B1611DVG) Don Torcuato VN-Ho Chi Minh City
Fax: 03 65 / 73 97-600 ITALIA Tel.: (00848) 812 0545 Etx: 215 & 214
HYDAC S.p.A. rA-Tigre / Buenos Aires
I
D-13127 Berlin Tel.: (0039) 039 / 642211 E-Mail: [email protected] (Namibia, Zimbabwe)
Tel.: 0 30 / 475 98 40 Fax: (0039) 039 / 6899682 CHILE HYDAC Technology Pty Ltd.
rCH
Fax: 0 30 / 475 98 4-29 Internet: www.hydac.it HYDAC Chile 165 Van der Bijl Street
HYDAC-Büro Bremen E-mail: [email protected] Las Araucarias # 9080 - 9110 Edenvale 1614
Riedemannstraße 1 Parque Industrial Las Araucarias ZA-Johannesburg
INDIA Tel.: (0027) 11 723 90 80
IND
D-45141 Essen
Tel.: 02 01 / 3 20 89-0 Route d’Esch, C.P. 38
Fax: 02 01 / 32 84 41 L-3801 Schifflange
Tel.: (00352) 54 52 44
HYDAC-Büro Mitte Fax: (00352) 54 52 48
Dieselstr. 9
MALAYSIA
MAL
D-64293 Darmstadt
Tel.: 0 61 51 / 81 45-0 HYDAC Technology Sdn. Bhd.
Fax: 0 61 51 / 81 45-22 No. 16 Jalan Pengacara U1/48
Temasya Industrial Park
HYDAC-Büro Südwest MAL-40150 Shah Alalm
Rehgrabenstr. 3 Tel.: (0060) 3 -55670250
D-66125 Dudweiler Fax: (0060) 3 -55670252
Tel.: 0 68 97 / 509-01 E-mail: [email protected]
Fax: 0 68 97 / 509-1422
HYDAC-Büro Süd
Dieselstraße 30
D-71546 Aspach
Tel.: 0 71 91 / 34 51-0
Fax: 0 71 91 / 34 51-4033
Accumulator Technology 30.000
Global Presence.
Local Expertise.
www.hydac.com
Filter Technology 70.000
Electronic
Product Catalogue
Process Technology 77.000
Filter Systems 79.000
HYDAC Headquarters
HYDAC Companies
HYDAC Distributors and Service Partners
Accessories 61.000
Fax:
+49 6897 509-1726
E-Mail: [email protected]
Internet: www.hydac.com
E 180.000.2/11.13
E 180.000.2/11.13
Cooling Systems 5.700